diff options
author | qhuang8 <qhuang8@6f19259b-4bc3-4df7-8a09-765794883524> | 2007-06-27 14:52:40 +0000 |
---|---|---|
committer | qhuang8 <qhuang8@6f19259b-4bc3-4df7-8a09-765794883524> | 2007-06-27 14:52:40 +0000 |
commit | d7dec593eaf18c9c2e197e92a4434e21c4f8e9b7 (patch) | |
tree | 67906b4ef10dfd247ddb977e09c85d0a6ad30e99 | |
parent | eb5f1a7fc7fd6f2edb306ca001f19b218abf0d7d (diff) | |
download | edk2-d7dec593eaf18c9c2e197e92a4434e21c4f8e9b7.zip edk2-d7dec593eaf18c9c2e197e92a4434e21c4f8e9b7.tar.gz edk2-d7dec593eaf18c9c2e197e92a4434e21c4f8e9b7.tar.bz2 |
Add EBC, FTW, Crc32SectionExtract, NullMemoryTest modules.
CrcSectionExtract cannot build for now for some missing definitions.
git-svn-id: https://edk2.svn.sourceforge.net/svnroot/edk2/trunk/edk2@2813 6f19259b-4bc3-4df7-8a09-765794883524
40 files changed, 14183 insertions, 3 deletions
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dsc b/MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dsc index 680a113..f574cc8 100644 --- a/MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dsc +++ b/MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dsc @@ -289,6 +289,10 @@ PcdUefiLibMaxPrintBufferSize|gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid|320
PcdMaxSizeNonPopulateCapsule|gEfiEdkModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
PcdMaxSizePopulateCapsule|gEfiEdkModulePkgTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareBase|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareSize|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingBase|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingSize|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid|0x0
[PcdsPatchableInModule.common]
PcdDebugPrintErrorLevel|gEfiMdePkgTokenSpaceGuid|0x80000000
@@ -309,4 +313,8 @@ ${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Disk/Partition/Dxe/Partition.inf
${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Security/SecurityStub/Dxe/SecurityStub.inf
${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Capsule/RuntimeDxe/CapsuleRuntime.inf
+ ${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.inf
+ ${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.inf
+ ${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.inf
+ #${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.inf
${WORKSPACE}/MdeModulePkg/Bus/Pci/AtapiPassThru/Dxe/AtapiPassThru.inf
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Capsule/RuntimeDxe/CapsuleRuntime.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Capsule/RuntimeDxe/CapsuleRuntime.inf index e733d79..e599ebd 100644 --- a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Capsule/RuntimeDxe/CapsuleRuntime.inf +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Capsule/RuntimeDxe/CapsuleRuntime.inf @@ -57,10 +57,8 @@ ################################################################################
[Packages]
- MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
- IntelFrameworkPkg/IntelFrameworkPkg.dec
MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
-
+ IntelFrameworkPkg/IntelFrameworkPkg.dec
################################################################################
#
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.dxs b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.dxs new file mode 100644 index 0000000..4b083dd --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.dxs @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ Ebc.dxs
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Dependency expression file for EBC VM.
+
+--*/
+#include <DxeDepex.h>
+
+DEPENDENCY_START
+ TRUE
+DEPENDENCY_END
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7367062 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.inf @@ -0,0 +1,108 @@ +#/** @file
+# Component description file for Ebc module.
+#
+# This module for the EBC virtual machine implementation produces
+# EBC and EBC debug support protocols.
+# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+#
+# All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#
+#
+#**/
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Defines Section - statements that will be processed to create a Makefile.
+#
+################################################################################
+[Defines]
+ INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
+ BASE_NAME = Ebc
+ FILE_GUID = 13AC6DD0-73D0-11D4-B06B-00AA00BD6DE7
+ MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
+ VERSION_STRING = 1.0
+ EDK_RELEASE_VERSION = 0x00020000
+ EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x00020000
+
+ ENTRY_POINT = InitializeEbcDriver
+
+#
+# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
+#
+# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF
+#
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Sources Section - list of files that are required for the build to succeed.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Sources.common]
+ Ebc.dxs
+ EbcExecute.h
+ EbcExecute.c
+ EbcInt.h
+ EbcInt.c
+
+[Sources.Ia32]
+ Ia32/EbcSupport.c
+ Ia32/EbcLowLevel.S
+ Ia32/EbcLowLevel.asm
+
+[Sources.X64]
+ x64/EbcSupport.c
+ x64/EbcLowLevel.S
+ x64/EbcLowLevel.asm
+
+[Sources.IPF]
+ Ipf/EbcSupport.h
+ Ipf/EbcSupport.c
+ Ipf/EbcLowLevel.s
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Package Dependency Section - list of Package files that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Packages]
+ MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
+ IntelFrameworkPkg/IntelFrameworkPkg.dec
+
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Library Class Section - list of Library Classes that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[LibraryClasses]
+ MemoryAllocationLib
+ UefiBootServicesTableLib
+ BaseMemoryLib
+ UefiDriverEntryPoint
+ DebugLib
+ BaseLib
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Protocol C Name Section - list of Protocol and Protocol Notify C Names
+# that this module uses or produces.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Protocols]
+ gEfiDebugSupportProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_PRODUCED
+ gEfiEbcProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_PRODUCED
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.msa b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.msa new file mode 100644 index 0000000..957f700 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ebc.msa @@ -0,0 +1,80 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
+<ModuleSurfaceArea xmlns="http://www.TianoCore.org/2006/Edk2.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance">
+ <MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleName>Ebc</ModuleName>
+ <ModuleType>DXE_DRIVER</ModuleType>
+ <GuidValue>13AC6DD0-73D0-11D4-B06B-00AA00BD6DE7</GuidValue>
+ <Version>1.0</Version>
+ <Abstract>Component description file for Ebc module.</Abstract>
+ <Description>This module for the EBC virtual machine implementation produces
+ EBC and EBC debug support protocols.</Description>
+ <Copyright>Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation</Copyright>
+ <License>All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+ are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+ which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+ http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+ THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+ WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.</License>
+ <Specification>FRAMEWORK_BUILD_PACKAGING_SPECIFICATION 0x00000052</Specification>
+ </MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleDefinitions>
+ <SupportedArchitectures>IA32 X64 IPF</SupportedArchitectures>
+ <BinaryModule>false</BinaryModule>
+ <OutputFileBasename>Ebc</OutputFileBasename>
+ </ModuleDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>BaseLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>DebugLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiDriverEntryPoint</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>BaseMemoryLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiBootServicesTableLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>MemoryAllocationLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ </LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <SourceFiles>
+ <Filename>EbcInt.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>EbcInt.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>EbcExecute.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>EbcExecute.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>Ebc.dxs</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IA32" ToolChainFamily="MSFT">Ia32/EbcLowLevel.asm</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IA32" ToolChainFamily="GCC">Ia32/EbcLowLevel.S</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IA32">Ia32/EbcSupport.c</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="X64" ToolChainFamily="MSFT">x64/EbcLowLevel.asm</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="X64" ToolChainFamily="GCC">x64/EbcLowLevel.S</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="X64">x64/EbcSupport.c</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IPF">Ipf/EbcLowLevel.s</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IPF">Ipf/EbcSupport.c</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IPF">Ipf/EbcSupport.h</Filename>
+ </SourceFiles>
+ <PackageDependencies>
+ <Package PackageGuid="1E73767F-8F52-4603-AEB4-F29B510B6766"/>
+ <Package PackageGuid="2759ded5-bb57-4b06-af4f-c398fa552719"/>
+ </PackageDependencies>
+ <Protocols>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_PRODUCED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiEbcProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_PRODUCED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiDebugSupportProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ </Protocols>
+ <Externs>
+ <Specification>EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Specification>EDK_RELEASE_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Extern>
+ <ModuleEntryPoint>InitializeEbcDriver</ModuleEntryPoint>
+ </Extern>
+ </Externs>
+</ModuleSurfaceArea>
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..174e774 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.c @@ -0,0 +1,4564 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcExecute.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Contains code that implements the virtual machine.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "EbcInt.h"
+#include "EbcExecute.h"
+
+
+//
+// Define some useful data size constants to allow switch statements based on
+// size of operands or data.
+//
+#define DATA_SIZE_INVALID 0
+#define DATA_SIZE_8 1
+#define DATA_SIZE_16 2
+#define DATA_SIZE_32 4
+#define DATA_SIZE_64 8
+#define DATA_SIZE_N 48 // 4 or 8
+//
+// Structure we'll use to dispatch opcodes to execute functions.
+//
+typedef struct {
+ EFI_STATUS (*ExecuteFunction) (IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr);
+}
+VM_TABLE_ENTRY;
+
+typedef
+UINT64
+(*DATA_MANIP_EXEC_FUNCTION) (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT16
+VmReadIndex16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT32
+VmReadIndex32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT64
+VmReadIndex64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT8
+VmReadMem8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT16
+VmReadMem16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+VmReadMem32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+VmReadMem64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINTN
+VmReadMemN (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT8 Data
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT16 Data
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT32 Data
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT16
+VmReadCode16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+VmReadCode32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+VmReadCode64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT8
+VmReadImmed8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT16
+VmReadImmed16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT32
+VmReadImmed32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+INT64
+VmReadImmed64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINTN
+ConvertStackAddr (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN BOOLEAN IsSignedOperation
+ );
+
+//
+// Functions that execute VM opcodes
+//
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteBREAK (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteJMP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteJMP8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCALL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteRET (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCMP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCMPI (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVxx (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVI (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVIn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVREL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePUSHn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePUSH (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePOPn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePOP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteSignedDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteUnsignedDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteLOADSP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteSTORESP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVsnd (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVsnw (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+//
+// Data manipulation subfunctions
+//
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteNOT (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteNEG (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteADD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSUB (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMUL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMULU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteDIV (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteDIVU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMOD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMODU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteAND (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteOR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteXOR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSHL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSHR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteASHR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDB (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDW (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ );
+
+//
+// Once we retrieve the operands for the data manipulation instructions,
+// call these functions to perform the operation.
+//
+static CONST DATA_MANIP_EXEC_FUNCTION mDataManipDispatchTable[] = {
+ ExecuteNOT,
+ ExecuteNEG,
+ ExecuteADD,
+ ExecuteSUB,
+ ExecuteMUL,
+ ExecuteMULU,
+ ExecuteDIV,
+ ExecuteDIVU,
+ ExecuteMOD,
+ ExecuteMODU,
+ ExecuteAND,
+ ExecuteOR,
+ ExecuteXOR,
+ ExecuteSHL,
+ ExecuteSHR,
+ ExecuteASHR,
+ ExecuteEXTNDB,
+ ExecuteEXTNDW,
+ ExecuteEXTNDD,
+};
+
+static CONST VM_TABLE_ENTRY mVmOpcodeTable[] = {
+ { ExecuteBREAK }, // opcode 0x00
+ { ExecuteJMP }, // opcode 0x01
+ { ExecuteJMP8 }, // opcode 0x02
+ { ExecuteCALL }, // opcode 0x03
+ { ExecuteRET }, // opcode 0x04
+ { ExecuteCMP }, // opcode 0x05 CMPeq
+ { ExecuteCMP }, // opcode 0x06 CMPlte
+ { ExecuteCMP }, // opcode 0x07 CMPgte
+ { ExecuteCMP }, // opcode 0x08 CMPulte
+ { ExecuteCMP }, // opcode 0x09 CMPugte
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0A NOT
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0B NEG
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0C ADD
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0D SUB
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0E MUL
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x0F MULU
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x10 DIV
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x11 DIVU
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x12 MOD
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x13 MODU
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x14 AND
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x15 OR
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x16 XOR
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x17 SHL
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x18 SHR
+ { ExecuteSignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x19 ASHR
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x1A EXTNDB
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x1B EXTNDW
+ { ExecuteUnsignedDataManip }, // opcode 0x1C EXTNDD
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x1D MOVBW
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x1E MOVWW
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x1F MOVDW
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x20 MOVQW
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x21 MOVBD
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x22 MOVWD
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x23 MOVDD
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x24 MOVQD
+ { ExecuteMOVsnw }, // opcode 0x25 MOVsnw
+ { ExecuteMOVsnd }, // opcode 0x26 MOVsnd
+ { NULL }, // opcode 0x27
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x28 MOVqq
+ { ExecuteLOADSP }, // opcode 0x29 LOADSP SP1, R2
+ { ExecuteSTORESP }, // opcode 0x2A STORESP R1, SP2
+ { ExecutePUSH }, // opcode 0x2B PUSH {@}R1 [imm16]
+ { ExecutePOP }, // opcode 0x2C POP {@}R1 [imm16]
+ { ExecuteCMPI }, // opcode 0x2D CMPIEQ
+ { ExecuteCMPI }, // opcode 0x2E CMPILTE
+ { ExecuteCMPI }, // opcode 0x2F CMPIGTE
+ { ExecuteCMPI }, // opcode 0x30 CMPIULTE
+ { ExecuteCMPI }, // opcode 0x31 CMPIUGTE
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x32 MOVN
+ { ExecuteMOVxx }, // opcode 0x33 MOVND
+ { NULL }, // opcode 0x34
+ { ExecutePUSHn }, // opcode 0x35
+ { ExecutePOPn }, // opcode 0x36
+ { ExecuteMOVI }, // opcode 0x37 - mov immediate data
+ { ExecuteMOVIn }, // opcode 0x38 - mov immediate natural
+ { ExecuteMOVREL } // opcode 0x39 - move data relative to PC
+};
+
+//
+// Length of JMP instructions, depending on upper two bits of opcode.
+//
+static CONST UINT8 mJMPLen[] = { 2, 2, 6, 10 };
+
+//
+// Simple Debugger Protocol GUID
+//
+EFI_GUID mEbcSimpleDebuggerProtocolGuid = EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL_GUID;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcExecuteInstructions (
+ IN EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN OUT UINTN *InstructionCount
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Given a pointer to a new VM context, execute one or more instructions. This
+ function is only used for test purposes via the EBC VM test protocol.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - pointer to protocol interface
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ InstructionCount - how many instructions to execute. 0 if don't count.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_UNSUPPORTED
+ EFI_SUCCESS
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN ExecFunc;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN InstructionsLeft;
+ UINTN SavedInstructionCount;
+
+ Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
+
+ if (*InstructionCount == 0) {
+ InstructionsLeft = 1;
+ } else {
+ InstructionsLeft = *InstructionCount;
+ }
+
+ SavedInstructionCount = *InstructionCount;
+ *InstructionCount = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Index into the opcode table using the opcode byte for this instruction.
+ // This gives you the execute function, which we first test for null, then
+ // call it if it's not null.
+ //
+ while (InstructionsLeft != 0) {
+ ExecFunc = (UINTN) mVmOpcodeTable[(*VmPtr->Ip & 0x3F)].ExecuteFunction;
+ if (ExecFunc == (UINTN) NULL) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_INVALID_OPCODE, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ } else {
+ mVmOpcodeTable[(*VmPtr->Ip & 0x3F)].ExecuteFunction (VmPtr);
+ *InstructionCount = *InstructionCount + 1;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Decrement counter if applicable
+ //
+ if (SavedInstructionCount != 0) {
+ InstructionsLeft--;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcExecute (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute an EBC image from an entry point or from a published protocol.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to prepared VM context.
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EBC status.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN ExecFunc;
+ UINT8 StackCorrupted;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL *EbcSimpleDebugger;
+
+ mVmPtr = VmPtr;
+ EbcSimpleDebugger = NULL;
+ Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
+ StackCorrupted = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Make sure the magic value has been put on the stack before we got here.
+ //
+ if (*VmPtr->StackMagicPtr != (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE) {
+ StackCorrupted = 1;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) ((UINT8 *) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0] + 8);
+
+ //
+ // Try to get the debug support for EBC
+ //
+ DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN ();
+ Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (
+ &mEbcSimpleDebuggerProtocolGuid,
+ NULL,
+ (VOID **) &EbcSimpleDebugger
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ EbcSimpleDebugger = NULL;
+ }
+ DEBUG_CODE_END ();
+
+ //
+ // Save the start IP for debug. For example, if we take an exception we
+ // can print out the location of the exception relative to the entry point,
+ // which could then be used in a disassembly listing to find the problem.
+ //
+ VmPtr->EntryPoint = (VOID *) VmPtr->Ip;
+
+ //
+ // We'll wait for this flag to know when we're done. The RET
+ // instruction sets it if it runs out of stack.
+ //
+ VmPtr->StopFlags = 0;
+ while (!(VmPtr->StopFlags & STOPFLAG_APP_DONE)) {
+ //
+ // If we've found a simple debugger protocol, call it
+ //
+ DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN ();
+ if (EbcSimpleDebugger != NULL) {
+ EbcSimpleDebugger->Debugger (EbcSimpleDebugger, VmPtr);
+ }
+ DEBUG_CODE_END ();
+
+ //
+ // Verify the opcode is in range. Otherwise generate an exception.
+ //
+ if ((*VmPtr->Ip & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) >= (sizeof (mVmOpcodeTable) / sizeof (mVmOpcodeTable[0]))) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_INVALID_OPCODE, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ Status = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ goto Done;
+ }
+ //
+ // Use the opcode bits to index into the opcode dispatch table. If the
+ // function pointer is null then generate an exception.
+ //
+ ExecFunc = (UINTN) mVmOpcodeTable[(*VmPtr->Ip & OPCODE_M_OPCODE)].ExecuteFunction;
+ if (ExecFunc == (UINTN) NULL) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_INVALID_OPCODE, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ Status = EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ goto Done;
+ }
+ //
+ // The EBC VM is a strongly ordered processor, so perform a fence operation before
+ // and after each instruction is executed.
+ //
+ MemoryFence ();
+
+ mVmOpcodeTable[(*VmPtr->Ip & OPCODE_M_OPCODE)].ExecuteFunction (VmPtr);
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+
+ //
+ // If the step flag is set, signal an exception and continue. We don't
+ // clear it here. Assuming the debugger is responsible for clearing it.
+ //
+ if (VMFLAG_ISSET (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_STEP)) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_STEP, EXCEPTION_FLAG_NONE, VmPtr);
+ }
+ //
+ // Make sure stack has not been corrupted. Only report it once though.
+ //
+ if (!StackCorrupted && (*VmPtr->StackMagicPtr != (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE)) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_STACK_FAULT, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ StackCorrupted = 1;
+ }
+ if (!StackCorrupted && ((UINT64)VmPtr->R[0] <= (UINT64)(UINTN) VmPtr->StackTop)) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_STACK_FAULT, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ StackCorrupted = 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+Done:
+ mVmPtr = NULL;
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVxx (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the MOVxx instructions.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_UNSUPPORTED
+ EFI_SUCCESS
+
+Instruction format:
+
+ MOV[b|w|d|q|n]{w|d} {@}R1 {Index16|32}, {@}R2 {Index16|32}
+ MOVqq {@}R1 {Index64}, {@}R2 {Index64}
+
+ Copies contents of [R2] -> [R1], zero extending where required.
+
+ First character indicates the size of the move.
+ Second character indicates the size of the index(s).
+
+ Invalid to have R1 direct with index.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 OpcMasked;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ UINT8 MoveSize;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ INT32 Index32;
+ INT64 Index64Op1;
+ INT64 Index64Op2;
+ UINT64 Data64;
+ UINT64 DataMask;
+ UINTN Source;
+
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ OpcMasked = (UINT8) (Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE);
+
+ //
+ // Get the operands byte so we can get R1 and R2
+ //
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Assume no indexes
+ //
+ Index64Op1 = 0;
+ Index64Op2 = 0;
+ Data64 = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Determine if we have an index/immediate data. Base instruction size
+ // is 2 (opcode + operands). Add to this size each index specified.
+ //
+ Size = 2;
+ if (Opcode & (OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1 | OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2)) {
+ //
+ // Determine size of the index from the opcode. Then get it.
+ //
+ if ((OpcMasked <= OPCODE_MOVQW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVNW)) {
+ //
+ // MOVBW, MOVWW, MOVDW, MOVQW, and MOVNW have 16-bit immediate index.
+ // Get one or both index values.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Index64Op1 = (INT64) Index16;
+ Size += sizeof (UINT16);
+ }
+
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Index64Op2 = (INT64) Index16;
+ Size += sizeof (UINT16);
+ }
+ } else if ((OpcMasked <= OPCODE_MOVQD) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVND)) {
+ //
+ // MOVBD, MOVWD, MOVDD, MOVQD, and MOVND have 32-bit immediate index
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ Index32 = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Index64Op1 = (INT64) Index32;
+ Size += sizeof (UINT32);
+ }
+
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ Index32 = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Index64Op2 = (INT64) Index32;
+ Size += sizeof (UINT32);
+ }
+ } else if (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVQQ) {
+ //
+ // MOVqq -- only form with a 64-bit index
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ Index64Op1 = VmReadIndex64 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size += sizeof (UINT64);
+ }
+
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ Index64Op2 = VmReadIndex64 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += sizeof (UINT64);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Obsolete MOVBQ, MOVWQ, MOVDQ, and MOVNQ have 64-bit immediate index
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Determine the size of the move, and create a mask for it so we can
+ // clear unused bits.
+ //
+ if ((OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVBW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVBD)) {
+ MoveSize = DATA_SIZE_8;
+ DataMask = 0xFF;
+ } else if ((OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVWW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVWD)) {
+ MoveSize = DATA_SIZE_16;
+ DataMask = 0xFFFF;
+ } else if ((OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVDW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVDD)) {
+ MoveSize = DATA_SIZE_32;
+ DataMask = 0xFFFFFFFF;
+ } else if ((OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVQW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVQD) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVQQ)) {
+ MoveSize = DATA_SIZE_64;
+ DataMask = (UINT64)~0;
+ } else if ((OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVNW) || (OpcMasked == OPCODE_MOVND)) {
+ MoveSize = DATA_SIZE_N;
+ DataMask = (UINT64)~0 >> (64 - 8 * sizeof (UINTN));
+ } else {
+ //
+ // We were dispatched to this function and we don't recognize the opcode
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_UNDEFINED, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now get the source address
+ //
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Indirect form @R2. Compute address of operand2
+ //
+ Source = (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index64Op2);
+ //
+ // Now get the data from the source. Always 0-extend and let the compiler
+ // sign-extend where required.
+ //
+ switch (MoveSize) {
+ case DATA_SIZE_8:
+ Data64 = (UINT64) (UINT8) VmReadMem8 (VmPtr, Source);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_16:
+ Data64 = (UINT64) (UINT16) VmReadMem16 (VmPtr, Source);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_32:
+ Data64 = (UINT64) (UINT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, Source);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_64:
+ Data64 = (UINT64) VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, Source);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_N:
+ Data64 = (UINT64) (UINTN) VmReadMemN (VmPtr, Source);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ //
+ // not reached
+ //
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Not indirect source: MOVxx {@}Rx, Ry [Index]
+ //
+ Data64 = VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index64Op2;
+ //
+ // Did Operand2 have an index? If so, treat as two signed values since
+ // indexes are signed values.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ //
+ // NOTE: need to find a way to fix this, most likely by changing the VM
+ // implementation to remove the stack gap. To do that, we'd need to
+ // allocate stack space for the VM and actually set the system
+ // stack pointer to the allocated buffer when the VM starts.
+ //
+ // Special case -- if someone took the address of a function parameter
+ // then we need to make sure it's not in the stack gap. We can identify
+ // this situation if (Operand2 register == 0) && (Operand2 is direct)
+ // && (Index applies to Operand2) && (Index > 0) && (Operand1 register != 0)
+ // Situations that to be aware of:
+ // * stack adjustments at beginning and end of functions R0 = R0 += stacksize
+ //
+ if ((OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands) == 0) &&
+ (!OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) &&
+ (Index64Op2 > 0) &&
+ (OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands) == 0) &&
+ (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands))
+ ) {
+ Data64 = (UINT64) ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, (UINTN) (INT64) Data64);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Now write it back
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Reuse the Source variable to now be dest.
+ //
+ Source = (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index64Op1);
+ //
+ // Do the write based on the size
+ //
+ switch (MoveSize) {
+ case DATA_SIZE_8:
+ VmWriteMem8 (VmPtr, Source, (UINT8) Data64);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_16:
+ VmWriteMem16 (VmPtr, Source, (UINT16) Data64);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_32:
+ VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, Source, (UINT32) Data64);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_64:
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, Source, Data64);
+ break;
+
+ case DATA_SIZE_N:
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, Source, (UINTN) Data64);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ //
+ // not reached
+ //
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Operand1 direct.
+ // Make sure we didn't have an index on operand1.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Direct storage in register. Clear unused bits and store back to
+ // register.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = Data64 & DataMask;
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteBREAK (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC BREAK instruction
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to current VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_UNSUPPORTED
+ EFI_SUCCESS
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ VOID *EbcEntryPoint;
+ VOID *Thunk;
+ UINT64 U64EbcEntryPoint;
+ INT32 Offset;
+
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ switch (Operands) {
+ //
+ // Runaway program break. Generate an exception and terminate
+ //
+ case 0:
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_BAD_BREAK, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Get VM version -- return VM revision number in R7
+ //
+ case 1:
+ //
+ // Bits:
+ // 63-17 = 0
+ // 16-8 = Major version
+ // 7-0 = Minor version
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[7] = GetVmVersion ();
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Debugger breakpoint
+ //
+ case 3:
+ VmPtr->StopFlags |= STOPFLAG_BREAKPOINT;
+ //
+ // See if someone has registered a handler
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_BREAKPOINT,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_NONE,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // System call, which there are none, so NOP it.
+ //
+ case 4:
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Create a thunk for EBC code. R7 points to a 32-bit (in a 64-bit slot)
+ // "offset from self" pointer to the EBC entry point.
+ // After we're done, *(UINT64 *)R7 will be the address of the new thunk.
+ //
+ case 5:
+ Offset = (INT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[7]);
+ U64EbcEntryPoint = (UINT64) (VmPtr->R[7] + Offset + 4);
+ EbcEntryPoint = (VOID *) (UINTN) U64EbcEntryPoint;
+
+ //
+ // Now create a new thunk
+ //
+ EbcCreateThunks (VmPtr->ImageHandle, EbcEntryPoint, &Thunk, 0);
+
+ //
+ // Finally replace the EBC entry point memory with the thunk address
+ //
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[7], (UINT64) (UINTN) Thunk);
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Compiler setting version per value in R7
+ //
+ case 6:
+ VmPtr->CompilerVersion = (UINT32) VmPtr->R[7];
+ //
+ // Check compiler version against VM version?
+ //
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Unhandled break code. Signal exception.
+ //
+ default:
+ EbcDebugSignalException (EXCEPT_EBC_BAD_BREAK, EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL, VmPtr);
+ break;
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance IP
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteJMP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the JMP instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ JMP64{cs|cc} Immed64
+ JMP32{cs|cc} {@}R1 {Immed32|Index32}
+
+Encoding:
+ b0.7 - immediate data present
+ b0.6 - 1 = 64 bit immediate data
+ 0 = 32 bit immediate data
+ b1.7 - 1 = conditional
+ b1.6 1 = CS (condition set)
+ 0 = CC (condition clear)
+ b1.4 1 = relative address
+ 0 = absolute address
+ b1.3 1 = operand1 indirect
+ b1.2-0 operand 1
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 CompareSet;
+ UINT8 ConditionFlag;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ UINT8 Operand;
+ UINT64 Data64;
+ INT32 Index32;
+ UINTN Addr;
+
+ Operand = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get instruction length from the opcode. The upper two bits are used here
+ // to index into the length array.
+ //
+ Size = mJMPLen[(Opcode >> 6) & 0x03];
+
+ //
+ // Decode instruction conditions
+ // If we haven't met the condition, then simply advance the IP and return.
+ //
+ CompareSet = (UINT8) ((Operand & JMP_M_CS) ? 1 : 0);
+ ConditionFlag = (UINT8) VMFLAG_ISSET (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+ if (Operand & CONDITION_M_CONDITIONAL) {
+ if (CompareSet != ConditionFlag) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Check for 64-bit form and do it right away since it's the most
+ // straight-forward form.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA64) {
+ //
+ // Double check for immediate-data, which is required. If not there,
+ // then signal an exception
+ //
+ if (!(Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA)) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_ERROR,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // 64-bit immediate data is full address. Read the immediate data,
+ // check for alignment, and jump absolute.
+ //
+ Data64 = VmReadImmed64 (VmPtr, 2);
+ if (!IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) Data64, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Take jump -- relative or absolute
+ //
+ if (Operand & JMP_M_RELATIVE) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += (UINTN) Data64 + Size;
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) Data64;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+ }
+ //
+ // 32-bit forms:
+ // Get the index if there is one. May be either an index, or an immediate
+ // offset depending on indirect operand.
+ // JMP32 @R1 Index32 -- immediate data is an index
+ // JMP32 R1 Immed32 -- immedate data is an offset
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operand)) {
+ Index32 = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index32 = VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+ } else {
+ Index32 = 0;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the register data. If R == 0, then special case where it's ignored.
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operand) == 0) {
+ Data64 = 0;
+ } else {
+ Data64 = OPERAND1_REGDATA (VmPtr, Operand);
+ }
+ //
+ // Decode the forms
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operand)) {
+ //
+ // Form: JMP32 @Rx {Index32}
+ //
+ Addr = VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) Data64 + Index32);
+ if (!IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) Addr, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ if (Operand & JMP_M_RELATIVE) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += (UINTN) Addr + Size;
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Form: JMP32 Rx {Immed32}
+ //
+ Addr = (UINTN) (Data64 + Index32);
+ if (!IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) Addr, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ if (Operand & JMP_M_RELATIVE) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += (UINTN) Addr + Size;
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteJMP8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC JMP8 instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ JMP8{cs|cc} Offset/2
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 ConditionFlag;
+ UINT8 CompareSet;
+ INT8 Offset;
+
+ //
+ // Decode instruction.
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ CompareSet = (UINT8) ((Opcode & JMP_M_CS) ? 1 : 0);
+ ConditionFlag = (UINT8) VMFLAG_ISSET (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+
+ //
+ // If we haven't met the condition, then simply advance the IP and return
+ //
+ if (Opcode & CONDITION_M_CONDITIONAL) {
+ if (CompareSet != ConditionFlag) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the offset from the instruction stream. It's relative to the
+ // following instruction, and divided by 2.
+ //
+ Offset = VmReadImmed8 (VmPtr, 1);
+ //
+ // Want to check for offset == -2 and then raise an exception?
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += (Offset * 2) + 2;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVI (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MOVI
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+
+ MOVI[b|w|d|q][w|d|q] {@}R1 {Index16}, ImmData16|32|64
+
+ First variable character specifies the move size
+ Second variable character specifies size of the immediate data
+
+ Sign-extend the immediate data to the size of the operation, and zero-extend
+ if storing to a register.
+
+ Operand1 direct with index/immed is invalid.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ INT64 ImmData64;
+ UINT64 Op1;
+ UINT64 Mask64;
+
+ //
+ // Get the opcode and operands byte so we can get R1 and R2
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get the index (16-bit) if present
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size = 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Extract the immediate data. Sign-extend always.
+ //
+ if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH16) {
+ ImmData64 = (INT64) (INT16) VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 2;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH32) {
+ ImmData64 = (INT64) (INT32) VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 4;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH64) {
+ ImmData64 = (INT64) VmReadImmed64 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 8;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Invalid encoding
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now write back the result
+ //
+ if (!OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Operand1 direct. Make sure it didn't have an index.
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Writing directly to a register. Clear unused bits.
+ //
+ if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH8) {
+ Mask64 = 0x000000FF;
+ } else if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH16) {
+ Mask64 = 0x0000FFFF;
+ } else if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH32) {
+ Mask64 = 0x00000000FFFFFFFF;
+ } else {
+ Mask64 = (UINT64)~0;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = ImmData64 & Mask64;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Get the address then write back based on size of the move
+ //
+ Op1 = (UINT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH8) {
+ VmWriteMem8 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (UINT8) ImmData64);
+ } else if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH16) {
+ VmWriteMem16 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (UINT16) ImmData64);
+ } else if ((Operands & MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH) == MOVI_MOVEWIDTH32) {
+ VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (UINT32) ImmData64);
+ } else {
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, ImmData64);
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVIn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MOV immediate natural. This instruction moves an immediate
+ index value into a register or memory location.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+
+ MOVIn[w|d|q] {@}R1 {Index16}, Index16|32|64
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ INT16 ImmedIndex16;
+ INT32 ImmedIndex32;
+ INT64 ImmedIndex64;
+ UINT64 Op1;
+
+ //
+ // Get the opcode and operands byte so we can get R1 and R2
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get the operand1 index (16-bit) if present
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size = 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Extract the immediate data and convert to a 64-bit index.
+ //
+ if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH16) {
+ ImmedIndex16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ ImmedIndex64 = (INT64) ImmedIndex16;
+ Size += 2;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH32) {
+ ImmedIndex32 = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ ImmedIndex64 = (INT64) ImmedIndex32;
+ Size += 4;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH64) {
+ ImmedIndex64 = VmReadIndex64 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 8;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Invalid encoding
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now write back the result
+ //
+ if (!OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Check for MOVIn R1 Index16, Immed (not indirect, with index), which
+ // is illegal
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = ImmedIndex64;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Get the address
+ //
+ Op1 = (UINT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (INTN) ImmedIndex64);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVREL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MOVREL instruction.
+ Dest <- Ip + ImmData
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+
+ MOVREL[w|d|q] {@}R1 {Index16}, ImmData16|32|64
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ INT64 ImmData64;
+ UINT64 Op1;
+ UINT64 Op2;
+
+ //
+ // Get the opcode and operands byte so we can get R1 and R2
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get the Operand 1 index (16-bit) if present
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size = 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the immediate data.
+ //
+ if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH16) {
+ ImmData64 = (INT64) VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 2;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH32) {
+ ImmData64 = (INT64) VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 4;
+ } else if ((Opcode & MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH) == MOVI_DATAWIDTH64) {
+ ImmData64 = VmReadImmed64 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 8;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Invalid encoding
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Compute the value and write back the result
+ //
+ Op2 = (UINT64) ((INT64) ((UINT64) (UINTN) VmPtr->Ip) + (INT64) ImmData64 + Size);
+ if (!OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Check for illegal combination of operand1 direct with immediate data
+ //
+ if (Operands & MOVI_M_IMMDATA) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = (VM_REGISTER) Op2;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Get the address = [Rx] + Index16
+ // Write back the result. Always a natural size write, since
+ // we're talking addresses here.
+ //
+ Op1 = (UINT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVsnw (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MOVsnw instruction. This instruction loads a signed
+ natural value from memory or register to another memory or register. On
+ 32-bit machines, the value gets sign-extended to 64 bits if the destination
+ is a register.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+
+ MOVsnw {@}R1 {Index16}, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+ 0:7 1=>operand1 index present
+ 0:6 1=>operand2 index present
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT16 Op1Index;
+ INT16 Op2Index;
+ UINT64 Op2;
+
+ //
+ // Get the opcode and operand bytes
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ Op1Index = Op2Index = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Get the indexes if present.
+ //
+ Size = 2;
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op1Index = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Illegal form operand1 direct with index: MOVsnw R1 Index16, {@}R2
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ Size += sizeof (UINT16);
+ }
+
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op2Index = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ } else {
+ Op2Index = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, Size);
+ }
+
+ Size += sizeof (UINT16);
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the data from the source.
+ //
+ Op2 = (INT64) ((INTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Op2Index));
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op2 = (INT64) (INTN) VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Now write back the result.
+ //
+ if (!OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = Op2;
+ } else {
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Op1Index), (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteMOVsnd (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MOVsnw instruction. This instruction loads a signed
+ natural value from memory or register to another memory or register. On
+ 32-bit machines, the value gets sign-extended to 64 bits if the destination
+ is a register.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+
+ MOVsnd {@}R1 {Indx32}, {@}R2 {Index32|Immed32}
+
+ 0:7 1=>operand1 index present
+ 0:6 1=>operand2 index present
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT32 Op1Index;
+ INT32 Op2Index;
+ UINT64 Op2;
+
+ //
+ // Get the opcode and operand bytes
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ Op1Index = Op2Index = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Get the indexes if present.
+ //
+ Size = 2;
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op1Index = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Illegal form operand1 direct with index: MOVsnd R1 Index16,..
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ Size += sizeof (UINT32);
+ }
+
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2) {
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op2Index = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ } else {
+ Op2Index = VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ }
+
+ Size += sizeof (UINT32);
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the data from the source.
+ //
+ Op2 = (INT64) ((INTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Op2Index));
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op2 = (INT64) (INTN) VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Now write back the result.
+ //
+ if (!OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = Op2;
+ } else {
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Op1Index), (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePUSHn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC PUSHn instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ PUSHn {@}R1 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ UINTN DataN;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get index if present
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the data to push
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ DataN = VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16));
+ } else {
+ DataN = (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16);
+ }
+ //
+ // Adjust the stack down.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], DataN);
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePUSH (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC PUSH instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ PUSH[32|64] {@}R1 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT32 Data32;
+ UINT64 Data64;
+ INT16 Index16;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ //
+ // Get immediate index if present, then advance the IP.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the data to push
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_64) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Data64 = VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16));
+ } else {
+ Data64 = (UINT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ }
+ //
+ // Adjust the stack down, then write back the data
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= sizeof (UINT64);
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], Data64);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 32-bit data
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Data32 = VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16));
+ } else {
+ Data32 = (UINT32) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ }
+ //
+ // Adjust the stack down and write the data
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= sizeof (UINT32);
+ VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], Data32);
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePOPn (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC POPn instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ POPn {@}R1 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ UINTN DataN;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ //
+ // Get immediate data if present, and advance the IP
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Read the data off the stack, then adjust the stack pointer
+ //
+ DataN = VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0]);
+ VmPtr->R[0] += sizeof (UINTN);
+ //
+ // Do the write-back
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16), DataN);
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = (INT64) (UINT64) ((UINTN) DataN + Index16);
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecutePOP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC POP instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ POP {@}R1 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ INT32 Data32;
+ UINT64 Data64;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ //
+ // Get immediate data if present, and advance the IP.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the data off the stack, then write it to the appropriate location
+ //
+ if (Opcode & PUSHPOP_M_64) {
+ //
+ // Read the data off the stack, then adjust the stack pointer
+ //
+ Data64 = VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0]);
+ VmPtr->R[0] += sizeof (UINT64);
+ //
+ // Do the write-back
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16), Data64);
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = Data64 + Index16;
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 32-bit pop. Read it off the stack and adjust the stack pointer
+ //
+ Data32 = (INT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0]);
+ VmPtr->R[0] += sizeof (UINT32);
+ //
+ // Do the write-back
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16), Data32);
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = (INT64) Data32 + Index16;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCALL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Implements the EBC CALL instruction.
+
+ Instruction format:
+
+ CALL64 Immed64
+ CALL32 {@}R1 {Immed32|Index32}
+ CALLEX64 Immed64
+ CALLEX16 {@}R1 {Immed32}
+
+ If Rx == R0, then it's a PC relative call to PC = PC + imm32.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context.
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ INT32 Immed32;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT64 Immed64;
+ VOID *FramePtr;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ //
+ // Assign these as well to avoid compiler warnings
+ //
+ Immed64 = 0;
+ Immed32 = 0;
+
+ FramePtr = VmPtr->FramePtr;
+ //
+ // Determine the instruction size, and get immediate data if present
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA64) {
+ Immed64 = VmReadImmed64 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size = 10;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // If register operand is indirect, then the immediate data is an index
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Immed32 = VmReadIndex32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Immed32 = VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ Size = 6;
+ }
+ } else {
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // If it's a call to EBC, adjust the stack pointer down 16 bytes and
+ // put our return address and frame pointer on the VM stack.
+ //
+ if ((Operands & OPERAND_M_NATIVE_CALL) == 0) {
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINTN) FramePtr);
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0];
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINT64) (UINTN) (VmPtr->Ip + Size));
+ }
+ //
+ // If 64-bit data, then absolute jump only
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA64) {
+ //
+ // Native or EBC call?
+ //
+ if ((Operands & OPERAND_M_NATIVE_CALL) == 0) {
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) Immed64;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Call external function, get the return value, and advance the IP
+ //
+ EbcLLCALLEX (VmPtr, (UINTN) Immed64, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], FramePtr, Size);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Get the register data. If operand1 == 0, then ignore register and
+ // take immediate data as relative or absolute address.
+ // Compiler should take care of upper bits if 32-bit machine.
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands) != 0) {
+ Immed64 = (UINT64) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)];
+ }
+ //
+ // Get final address
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Immed64 = (INT64) (UINT64) (UINTN) VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) (Immed64 + Immed32));
+ } else {
+ Immed64 += Immed32;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now determine if external call, and then if relative or absolute
+ //
+ if ((Operands & OPERAND_M_NATIVE_CALL) == 0) {
+ //
+ // EBC call. Relative or absolute? If relative, then it's relative to the
+ // start of the next instruction.
+ //
+ if (Operands & OPERAND_M_RELATIVE_ADDR) {
+ VmPtr->Ip += Immed64 + Size;
+ } else {
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) Immed64;
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Native call. Relative or absolute?
+ //
+ if (Operands & OPERAND_M_RELATIVE_ADDR) {
+ EbcLLCALLEX (VmPtr, (UINTN) (Immed64 + VmPtr->Ip + Size), (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], FramePtr, Size);
+ } else {
+ if (VmPtr->StopFlags & STOPFLAG_BREAK_ON_CALLEX) {
+ CpuBreakpoint ();
+ }
+
+ EbcLLCALLEX (VmPtr, (UINTN) Immed64, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], FramePtr, Size);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteRET (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC RET instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ RET
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // If we're at the top of the stack, then simply set the done
+ // flag and return
+ //
+ if (VmPtr->StackRetAddr == (UINT64) VmPtr->R[0]) {
+ VmPtr->StopFlags |= STOPFLAG_APP_DONE;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Pull the return address off the VM app's stack and set the IP
+ // to it
+ //
+ if (!IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ }
+ //
+ // Restore the IP and frame pointer from the stack
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0]);
+ VmPtr->R[0] += 8;
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) VmReadMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0]);
+ VmPtr->R[0] += 8;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCMP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC CMP instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ CMP[32|64][eq|lte|gte|ulte|ugte] R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ UINT32 Flag;
+ INT64 Op2;
+ INT64 Op1;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+ //
+ // Get the register data we're going to compare to
+ //
+ Op1 = VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)];
+ //
+ // Get immediate data
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_IMMDATA) {
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ Size = 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now get Op2
+ //
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_64BIT) {
+ Op2 = (INT64) VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16));
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 32-bit operations. 0-extend the values for all cases.
+ //
+ Op2 = (INT64) (UINT64) ((UINT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16)));
+ }
+ } else {
+ Op2 = VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now do the compare
+ //
+ Flag = 0;
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_64BIT) {
+ //
+ // 64-bit compares
+ //
+ switch (Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) {
+ case OPCODE_CMPEQ:
+ if (Op1 == Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPLTE:
+ if (Op1 <= Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPGTE:
+ if (Op1 >= Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPULTE:
+ if ((UINT64) Op1 <= (UINT64) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPUGTE:
+ if ((UINT64) Op1 >= (UINT64) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ ASSERT (0);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 32-bit compares
+ //
+ switch (Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) {
+ case OPCODE_CMPEQ:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 == (INT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPLTE:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 <= (INT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPGTE:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 >= (INT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPULTE:
+ if ((UINT32) Op1 <= (UINT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPUGTE:
+ if ((UINT32) Op1 >= (UINT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ ASSERT (0);
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Now set the flag accordingly for the comparison
+ //
+ if (Flag) {
+ VMFLAG_SET (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+ } else {
+ VMFLAG_CLEAR (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the IP
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteCMPI (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC CMPI instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ CMPI[32|64]{w|d}[eq|lte|gte|ulte|ugte] {@}Rx {Index16}, Immed16|Immed32
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ INT64 Op1;
+ INT64 Op2;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ UINT32 Flag;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get operand1 index if present
+ //
+ Size = 2;
+ if (Operands & OPERAND_M_CMPI_INDEX) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ Size += 2;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ }
+ //
+ // Get operand1 data we're going to compare to
+ //
+ Op1 = (INT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)];
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Indirect operand1. Fetch 32 or 64-bit value based on compare size.
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_CMPI64) {
+ Op1 = (INT64) VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1 + Index16);
+ } else {
+ Op1 = (INT64) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1 + Index16);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Better not have been an index with direct. That is, CMPI R1 Index,...
+ // is illegal.
+ //
+ if (Operands & OPERAND_M_CMPI_INDEX) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_ERROR,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Get immediate data -- 16- or 32-bit sign extended
+ //
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_CMPI32_DATA) {
+ Op2 = (INT64) VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, Size);
+ Size += 4;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 16-bit immediate data. Sign extend always.
+ //
+ Op2 = (INT64) ((INT16) VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, Size));
+ Size += 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now do the compare
+ //
+ Flag = 0;
+ if (Opcode & OPCODE_M_CMPI64) {
+ //
+ // 64 bit comparison
+ //
+ switch (Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) {
+ case OPCODE_CMPIEQ:
+ if (Op1 == (INT64) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPILTE:
+ if (Op1 <= (INT64) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIGTE:
+ if (Op1 >= (INT64) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIULTE:
+ if ((UINT64) Op1 <= (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op2)) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIUGTE:
+ if ((UINT64) Op1 >= (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op2)) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ ASSERT (0);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // 32-bit comparisons
+ //
+ switch (Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) {
+ case OPCODE_CMPIEQ:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 == Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPILTE:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 <= Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIGTE:
+ if ((INT32) Op1 >= Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIULTE:
+ if ((UINT32) Op1 <= (UINT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case OPCODE_CMPIUGTE:
+ if ((UINT32) Op1 >= (UINT32) Op2) {
+ Flag = 1;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ ASSERT (0);
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Now set the flag accordingly for the comparison
+ //
+ if (Flag) {
+ VMFLAG_SET (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+ } else {
+ VMFLAG_CLEAR (VmPtr, VMFLAGS_CC);
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the IP
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteNOT (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC NOT instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ ~Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ NOT[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return ~Op2;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteNEG (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC NEG instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op2 * -1
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ NEG[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return ~Op2 + 1;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteADD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC ADD instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 + Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ ADD[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return Op1 + Op2;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSUB (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC SUB instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 - Op2
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ SUB[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return (UINT64) ((INT64) ((INT64) Op1 - (INT64) Op2));
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((INT64) ((INT32) Op1 - (INT32) Op2));
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMUL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC MUL instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 * Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ MUL[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return MultS64x64 ((INT64)Op1, (INT64)Op2);
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((INT64) ((INT32) Op1 * (INT32) Op2));
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMULU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC MULU instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ (unsigned)Op1 * (unsigned)Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ MULU[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return MultU64x64 (Op1, Op2);
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op1 * (UINT32) Op2);
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteDIV (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC DIV instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1/Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ DIV[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ INT64 Remainder;
+
+ //
+ // Check for divide-by-0
+ //
+ if (Op2 == 0) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_DIVIDE_ERROR,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+
+ return 0;
+ } else {
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return (UINT64) (DivS64x64Remainder (Op1, Op2, &Remainder));
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((INT64) ((INT32) Op1 / (INT32) Op2));
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteDIVU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC DIVU instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ (unsigned)Op1 / (unsigned)Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ DIVU[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT64 Remainder;
+
+ //
+ // Check for divide-by-0
+ //
+ if (Op2 == 0) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_DIVIDE_ERROR,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return 0;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Get the destination register
+ //
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return (UINT64) (DivU64x64Remainder ((INT64)Op1, (INT64)Op2, &Remainder));
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op1 / (UINT32) Op2);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMOD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC MOD instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 MODULUS Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ MOD[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ INT64 Remainder;
+
+ //
+ // Check for divide-by-0
+ //
+ if (Op2 == 0) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_DIVIDE_ERROR,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return 0;
+ } else {
+ DivS64x64Remainder ((INT64)Op1, (INT64)Op2, &Remainder);
+ return Remainder;
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteMODU (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC MODU instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 UNSIGNED_MODULUS Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ MODU[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT64 Remainder;
+
+ //
+ // Check for divide-by-0
+ //
+ if (Op2 == 0) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_DIVIDE_ERROR,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ return 0;
+ } else {
+ DivU64x64Remainder (Op1, Op2, &Remainder);
+ return Remainder;
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteAND (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC AND instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 AND Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ AND[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return Op1 & Op2;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteOR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC OR instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 OR Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ OR[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return Op1 | Op2;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteXOR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC XOR instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 XOR Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ XOR[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ return Op1 ^ Op2;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSHL (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Execute the EBC SHL shift left instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 << Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ SHL[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return LShiftU64 (Op1, (UINTN)Op2);
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((UINT32) ((UINT32) Op1 << (UINT32) Op2));
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteSHR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC SHR instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 >> Op2 (unsigned operands)
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ SHR[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return RShiftU64 (Op1, (UINTN)Op2);
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op1 >> (UINT32) Op2);
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteASHR (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC ASHR instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ Op1 >> Op2 (signed)
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ ASHR[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ if (*VmPtr->Ip & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ return ARShiftU64 (Op1, (UINTN)Op2);
+ } else {
+ return (UINT64) ((INT64) ((INT32) Op1 >> (UINT32) Op2));
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDB (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC EXTNDB instruction to sign-extend a byte value.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ (INT64)(INT8)Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ EXTNDB[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+
+--*/
+{
+ INT8 Data8;
+ INT64 Data64;
+ //
+ // Convert to byte, then return as 64-bit signed value to let compiler
+ // sign-extend the value
+ //
+ Data8 = (INT8) Op2;
+ Data64 = (INT64) Data8;
+
+ return (UINT64) Data64;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDW (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC EXTNDW instruction to sign-extend a 16-bit value.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ (INT64)(INT16)Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ EXTNDW[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+
+--*/
+{
+ INT16 Data16;
+ INT64 Data64;
+ //
+ // Convert to word, then return as 64-bit signed value to let compiler
+ // sign-extend the value
+ //
+ Data16 = (INT16) Op2;
+ Data64 = (INT64) Data16;
+
+ return (UINT64) Data64;
+}
+//
+// Execute the EBC EXTNDD instruction.
+//
+// Format: EXTNDD {@}Rx, {@}Ry [Index16|Immed16]
+// EXTNDD Dest, Source
+//
+// Operation: Dest <- SignExtended((DWORD)Source))
+//
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEXTNDD (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT64 Op1,
+ IN UINT64 Op2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC EXTNDD instruction to sign-extend a 32-bit value.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Op1 - Operand 1 from the instruction
+ Op2 - Operand 2 from the instruction
+
+Returns:
+ (INT64)(INT32)Op2
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ EXTNDD[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+
+
+--*/
+{
+ INT32 Data32;
+ INT64 Data64;
+ //
+ // Convert to 32-bit value, then return as 64-bit signed value to let compiler
+ // sign-extend the value
+ //
+ Data32 = (INT32) Op2;
+ Data64 = (INT64) Data32;
+
+ return (UINT64) Data64;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteSignedDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Just call the data manipulation function with a flag indicating this
+ // is a signed operation.
+ //
+ return ExecuteDataManip (VmPtr, TRUE);
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteUnsignedDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Just call the data manipulation function with a flag indicating this
+ // is not a signed operation.
+ //
+ return ExecuteDataManip (VmPtr, FALSE);
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteDataManip (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN BOOLEAN IsSignedOp
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute all the EBC data manipulation instructions.
+ Since the EBC data manipulation instructions all have the same basic form,
+ they can share the code that does the fetch of operands and the write-back
+ of the result. This function performs the fetch of the operands (even if
+ both are not needed to be fetched, like NOT instruction), dispatches to the
+ appropriate subfunction, then writes back the returned result.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EBC status
+
+Format:
+ INSTRUCITON[32|64] {@}R1, {@}R2 {Immed16|Index16}
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Opcode;
+ INT16 Index16;
+ UINT8 Operands;
+ UINT8 Size;
+ UINT64 Op1;
+ UINT64 Op2;
+
+ //
+ // Get opcode and operands
+ //
+ Opcode = GETOPCODE (VmPtr);
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Determine if we have immediate data by the opcode
+ //
+ if (Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_IMMDATA) {
+ //
+ // Index16 if Ry is indirect, or Immed16 if Ry direct.
+ //
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Index16 = VmReadIndex16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ } else {
+ Index16 = VmReadImmed16 (VmPtr, 2);
+ }
+
+ Size = 4;
+ } else {
+ Index16 = 0;
+ Size = 2;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now get operand2 (source). It's of format {@}R2 {Index16|Immed16}
+ //
+ Op2 = (UINT64) VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] + Index16;
+ if (OPERAND2_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Indirect form: @R2 Index16. Fetch as 32- or 64-bit data
+ //
+ if (Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ Op2 = VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op2);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Read as signed value where appropriate.
+ //
+ if (IsSignedOp) {
+ Op2 = (UINT64) (INT64) ((INT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op2));
+ } else {
+ Op2 = (UINT64) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op2);
+ }
+ }
+ } else {
+ if ((Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) == 0) {
+ if (IsSignedOp) {
+ Op2 = (UINT64) (INT64) ((INT32) Op2);
+ } else {
+ Op2 = (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op2);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Get operand1 (destination and sometimes also an actual operand)
+ // of form {@}R1
+ //
+ Op1 = VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)];
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ if (Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ Op1 = VmReadMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1);
+ } else {
+ if (IsSignedOp) {
+ Op1 = (UINT64) (INT64) ((INT32) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1));
+ } else {
+ Op1 = (UINT64) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1);
+ }
+ }
+ } else {
+ if ((Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) == 0) {
+ if (IsSignedOp) {
+ Op1 = (UINT64) (INT64) ((INT32) Op1);
+ } else {
+ Op1 = (UINT64) ((UINT32) Op1);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Dispatch to the computation function
+ //
+ if (((Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) - OPCODE_NOT) >=
+ (sizeof (mDataManipDispatchTable) / sizeof (mDataManipDispatchTable[0]))
+ ) {
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INVALID_OPCODE,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_ERROR,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ //
+ // Advance and return
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ } else {
+ Op2 = mDataManipDispatchTable[(Opcode & OPCODE_M_OPCODE) - OPCODE_NOT](VmPtr, Op1, Op2);
+ }
+ //
+ // Write back the result.
+ //
+ if (OPERAND1_INDIRECT (Operands)) {
+ Op1 = VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)];
+ if (Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) {
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, Op2);
+ } else {
+ VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, (UINTN) Op1, (UINT32) Op2);
+ }
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Storage back to a register. Write back, clearing upper bits (as per
+ // the specification) if 32-bit operation.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = Op2;
+ if ((Opcode & DATAMANIP_M_64) == 0) {
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] &= 0xFFFFFFFF;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Advance the instruction pointer
+ //
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteLOADSP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC LOADSP instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ LOADSP SP1, R2
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Operands;
+
+ //
+ // Get the operands
+ //
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Do the operation
+ //
+ switch (OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Set flags
+ //
+ case 0:
+ //
+ // Spec states that this instruction will not modify reserved bits in
+ // the flags register.
+ //
+ VmPtr->Flags = (VmPtr->Flags &~VMFLAGS_ALL_VALID) | (VmPtr->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)] & VMFLAGS_ALL_VALID);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_WARNING,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+ExecuteSTORESP (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Execute the EBC STORESP instruction
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+Instruction syntax:
+ STORESP Rx, FLAGS|IP
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 Operands;
+
+ //
+ // Get the operands
+ //
+ Operands = GETOPERANDS (VmPtr);
+
+ //
+ // Do the operation
+ //
+ switch (OPERAND2_REGNUM (Operands)) {
+ //
+ // Get flags
+ //
+ case 0:
+ //
+ // Retrieve the value in the flags register, then clear reserved bits
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = (UINT64) (VmPtr->Flags & VMFLAGS_ALL_VALID);
+ break;
+
+ //
+ // Get IP -- address of following instruction
+ //
+ case 1:
+ VmPtr->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (Operands)] = (UINT64) (UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + 2;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_INSTRUCTION_ENCODING,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_WARNING,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ VmPtr->Ip += 2;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT16
+VmReadIndex16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Decode a 16-bit index to determine the offset. Given an index value:
+
+ b15 - sign bit
+ b14:12 - number of bits in this index assigned to natural units (=a)
+ ba:11 - constant units = C
+ b0:a - natural units = N
+
+ Given this info, the offset can be computed by:
+ offset = sign_bit * (C + N * sizeof(UINTN))
+
+ Max offset is achieved with index = 0x7FFF giving an offset of
+ 0x27B (32-bit machine) or 0x477 (64-bit machine).
+ Min offset is achieved with index =
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+ CodeOffset - offset from IP of the location of the 16-bit index to decode
+
+Returns:
+ The decoded offset.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT16 Index;
+ INT16 Offset;
+ INT16 C;
+ INT16 N;
+ INT16 NBits;
+ INT16 Mask;
+
+ //
+ // First read the index from the code stream
+ //
+ Index = VmReadCode16 (VmPtr, CodeOffset);
+
+ //
+ // Get the mask for N. First get the number of bits from the index.
+ //
+ NBits = (INT16) ((Index & 0x7000) >> 12);
+
+ //
+ // Scale it for 16-bit indexes
+ //
+ NBits *= 2;
+
+ //
+ // Now using the number of bits, create a mask.
+ //
+ Mask = (INT16) ((INT16)~0 << NBits);
+
+ //
+ // Now using the mask, extract N from the lower bits of the index.
+ //
+ N = (INT16) (Index &~Mask);
+
+ //
+ // Now compute C
+ //
+ C = (INT16) (((Index &~0xF000) & Mask) >> NBits);
+
+ Offset = (INT16) (N * sizeof (UINTN) + C);
+
+ //
+ // Now set the sign
+ //
+ if (Index & 0x8000) {
+ //
+ // Do it the hard way to work around a bogus compiler warning
+ //
+ // Offset = -1 * Offset;
+ //
+ Offset = (INT16) ((INT32) Offset * -1);
+ }
+
+ return Offset;
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT32
+VmReadIndex32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Decode a 32-bit index to determine the offset.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+ CodeOffset - offset from IP of the location of the 32-bit index to decode
+
+Returns:
+ Converted index per EBC VM specification
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT32 Index;
+ INT32 Offset;
+ INT32 C;
+ INT32 N;
+ INT32 NBits;
+ INT32 Mask;
+
+ Index = VmReadImmed32 (VmPtr, CodeOffset);
+
+ //
+ // Get the mask for N. First get the number of bits from the index.
+ //
+ NBits = (Index & 0x70000000) >> 28;
+
+ //
+ // Scale it for 32-bit indexes
+ //
+ NBits *= 4;
+
+ //
+ // Now using the number of bits, create a mask.
+ //
+ Mask = (INT32)~0 << NBits;
+
+ //
+ // Now using the mask, extract N from the lower bits of the index.
+ //
+ N = Index &~Mask;
+
+ //
+ // Now compute C
+ //
+ C = ((Index &~0xF0000000) & Mask) >> NBits;
+
+ Offset = N * sizeof (UINTN) + C;
+
+ //
+ // Now set the sign
+ //
+ if (Index & 0x80000000) {
+ Offset = Offset * -1;
+ }
+
+ return Offset;
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT64
+VmReadIndex64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 CodeOffset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Decode a 64-bit index to determine the offset.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+ CodeOffset - offset from IP of the location of the 64-bit index to decode
+
+Returns:
+ Converted index per EBC VM specification
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT64 Index;
+ INT64 Offset;
+ INT64 C;
+ INT64 N;
+ INT64 NBits;
+ INT64 Mask;
+
+ Index = VmReadCode64 (VmPtr, CodeOffset);
+
+ //
+ // Get the mask for N. First get the number of bits from the index.
+ //
+ NBits = RShiftU64 ((Index & 0x7000000000000000ULL), 60);
+
+ //
+ // Scale it for 64-bit indexes (multiply by 8 by shifting left 3)
+ //
+ NBits = LShiftU64 ((UINT64)NBits, 3);
+
+ //
+ // Now using the number of bits, create a mask.
+ //
+ Mask = (LShiftU64 ((UINT64)~0, (UINTN)NBits));
+
+ //
+ // Now using the mask, extract N from the lower bits of the index.
+ //
+ N = Index &~Mask;
+
+ //
+ // Now compute C
+ //
+ C = ARShiftU64 (((Index &~0xF000000000000000ULL) & Mask), (UINTN)NBits);
+
+ Offset = MultU64x64 (N, sizeof (UINTN)) + C;
+
+ //
+ // Now set the sign
+ //
+ if (Index & 0x8000000000000000ULL) {
+ Offset = MultS64x64 (Offset, -1);
+ }
+
+ return Offset;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT8 Data
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ The following VmWriteMem? routines are called by the EBC data
+ movement instructions that write to memory. Since these writes
+ may be to the stack, which looks like (high address on top) this,
+
+ [EBC entry point arguments]
+ [VM stack]
+ [EBC stack]
+
+ we need to detect all attempts to write to the EBC entry point argument
+ stack area and adjust the address (which will initially point into the
+ VM stack) to point into the EBC entry point arguments.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Addr - adddress to write to
+ Data - value to write to Addr
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+ *(UINT8 *) Addr = Data;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT16 Data
+ )
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+
+ //
+ // Do a simple write if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ *(UINT16 *) Addr = Data;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Write as two bytes
+ //
+ MemoryFence ();
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem8 (VmPtr, Addr, (UINT8) Data)) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem8 (VmPtr, Addr + 1, (UINT8) (Data >> 8))) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT32 Data
+ )
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+
+ //
+ // Do a simple write if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT32))) {
+ *(UINT32 *) Addr = Data;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Write as two words
+ //
+ MemoryFence ();
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem16 (VmPtr, Addr, (UINT16) Data)) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem16 (VmPtr, Addr + sizeof (UINT16), (UINT16) (Data >> 16))) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT64 Data
+ )
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINT32 Data32;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+
+ //
+ // Do a simple write if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT64))) {
+ *(UINT64 *) Addr = Data;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Write as two 32-bit words
+ //
+ MemoryFence ();
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, Addr, (UINT32) Data)) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ Data32 = (UINT32) (((UINT32 *) &Data)[1]);
+ if ((Status = VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, Addr + sizeof (UINT32), Data32)) != EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ MemoryFence ();
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMemN (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINTN Data
+ )
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Index;
+
+ Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+
+ //
+ // Do a simple write if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINTN))) {
+ *(UINTN *) Addr = Data;
+ } else {
+ for (Index = 0; Index < sizeof (UINTN) / sizeof (UINT32); Index++) {
+ MemoryFence ();
+ Status = VmWriteMem32 (VmPtr, Addr + Index * sizeof (UINT32), (UINT32) Data);
+ MemoryFence ();
+ Data = (UINTN)RShiftU64 ((UINT64)Data, 32);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT8
+VmReadImmed8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The following VmReadImmed routines are called by the EBC execute
+ functions to read EBC immediate values from the code stream.
+ Since we can't assume alignment, each tries to read in the biggest
+ chunks size available, but will revert to smaller reads if necessary.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context
+ Offset - offset from IP of the code bytes to read.
+
+Returns:
+ Signed data of the requested size from the specified address.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Simply return the data in flat memory space
+ //
+ return * (INT8 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT16
+VmReadImmed16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (INT16))) {
+ return * (INT16 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // All code word reads should be aligned
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_WARNING,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ return (INT16) (*(UINT8 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset) + (*(UINT8 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset + 1) << 8));
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT32
+VmReadImmed32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+{
+ UINT32 Data;
+
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (UINT32))) {
+ return * (INT32 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ Data = (UINT32) VmReadCode16 (VmPtr, Offset);
+ Data |= (UINT32) (VmReadCode16 (VmPtr, Offset + 2) << 16);
+ return Data;
+}
+
+STATIC
+INT64
+VmReadImmed64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+{
+ UINT64 Data64;
+ UINT32 Data32;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (UINT64))) {
+ return * (UINT64 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data.
+ //
+ Ptr = (UINT8 *) &Data64;
+ Data32 = VmReadCode32 (VmPtr, Offset);
+ *(UINT32 *) Ptr = Data32;
+ Ptr += sizeof (Data32);
+ Data32 = VmReadCode32 (VmPtr, Offset + sizeof (UINT32));
+ *(UINT32 *) Ptr = Data32;
+ return Data64;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT16
+VmReadCode16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ The following VmReadCode() routines provide the ability to read raw
+ unsigned data from the code stream.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+ Offset - offset from current IP to the raw data to read.
+
+Returns:
+ The raw unsigned 16-bit value from the code stream.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ return * (UINT16 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // All code word reads should be aligned
+ //
+ EbcDebugSignalException (
+ EXCEPT_EBC_ALIGNMENT_CHECK,
+ EXCEPTION_FLAG_WARNING,
+ VmPtr
+ );
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ return (UINT16) (*(UINT8 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset) + (*(UINT8 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset + 1) << 8));
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+VmReadCode32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+{
+ UINT32 Data;
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (UINT32))) {
+ return * (UINT32 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ Data = (UINT32) VmReadCode16 (VmPtr, Offset);
+ Data |= (VmReadCode16 (VmPtr, Offset + 2) << 16);
+ return Data;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+VmReadCode64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+{
+ UINT64 Data64;
+ UINT32 Data32;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED ((UINTN) VmPtr->Ip + Offset, sizeof (UINT64))) {
+ return * (UINT64 *) (VmPtr->Ip + Offset);
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data.
+ //
+ Ptr = (UINT8 *) &Data64;
+ Data32 = VmReadCode32 (VmPtr, Offset);
+ *(UINT32 *) Ptr = Data32;
+ Ptr += sizeof (Data32);
+ Data32 = VmReadCode32 (VmPtr, Offset + sizeof (UINT32));
+ *(UINT32 *) Ptr = Data32;
+ return Data64;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT8
+VmReadMem8 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+ //
+ // Simply return the data in flat memory space
+ //
+ return * (UINT8 *) Addr;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT16
+VmReadMem16 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT16))) {
+ return * (UINT16 *) Addr;
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ return (UINT16) (*(UINT8 *) Addr + (*(UINT8 *) (Addr + 1) << 8));
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+VmReadMem32 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+{
+ UINT32 Data;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT32))) {
+ return * (UINT32 *) Addr;
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ Data = (UINT32) VmReadMem16 (VmPtr, Addr);
+ Data |= (VmReadMem16 (VmPtr, Addr + 2) << 16);
+ return Data;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+VmReadMem64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+{
+ UINT64 Data;
+ UINT32 Data32;
+
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINT64))) {
+ return * (UINT64 *) Addr;
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data. Assume little endian.
+ //
+ Data = (UINT64) VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, Addr);
+ Data32 = VmReadMem32 (VmPtr, Addr + sizeof (UINT32));
+ *(UINT32 *) ((UINT32 *) &Data + 1) = Data32;
+ return Data;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINTN
+ConvertStackAddr (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Given an address that EBC is going to read from or write to, return
+ an appropriate address that accounts for a gap in the stack.
+
+ The stack for this application looks like this (high addr on top)
+ [EBC entry point arguments]
+ [VM stack]
+ [EBC stack]
+
+ The EBC assumes that its arguments are at the top of its stack, which
+ is where the VM stack is really. Therefore if the EBC does memory
+ accesses into the VM stack area, then we need to convert the address
+ to point to the EBC entry point arguments area. Do this here.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to VM context
+ Addr - address of interest
+
+Returns:
+
+ The unchanged address if it's not in the VM stack region. Otherwise,
+ adjust for the stack gap and return the modified address.
+
+--*/
+{
+ ASSERT(((Addr < VmPtr->LowStackTop) || (Addr > VmPtr->HighStackBottom)));
+ return Addr;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINTN
+VmReadMemN (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Read a natural value from memory. May or may not be aligned.
+
+Arguments:
+ VmPtr - current VM context
+ Addr - the address to read from
+
+Returns:
+ The natural value at address Addr.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN Data;
+ volatile UINT32 Size;
+ UINT8 *FromPtr;
+ UINT8 *ToPtr;
+ //
+ // Convert the address if it's in the stack gap
+ //
+ Addr = ConvertStackAddr (VmPtr, Addr);
+ //
+ // Read direct if aligned
+ //
+ if (IS_ALIGNED (Addr, sizeof (UINTN))) {
+ return * (UINTN *) Addr;
+ }
+ //
+ // Return unaligned data
+ //
+ Data = 0;
+ FromPtr = (UINT8 *) Addr;
+ ToPtr = (UINT8 *) &Data;
+
+ for (Size = 0; Size < sizeof (Data); Size++) {
+ *ToPtr = *FromPtr;
+ ToPtr++;
+ FromPtr++;
+ }
+
+ return Data;
+}
+
+UINT64
+GetVmVersion (
+ VOID
+ )
+{
+ return (UINT64) (((VM_MAJOR_VERSION & 0xFFFF) << 16) | ((VM_MINOR_VERSION & 0xFFFF)));
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..b1926ee --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcExecute.h @@ -0,0 +1,323 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcExecute.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Header file for Virtual Machine support. Contains EBC defines that can
+ be of use to a disassembler for the most part. Also provides function
+ prototypes for VM functions.
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _EBC_EXECUTE_H_
+#define _EBC_EXECUTE_H_
+
+//
+// VM major/minor version
+//
+#define VM_MAJOR_VERSION 1
+#define VM_MINOR_VERSION 0
+
+//
+// Macros to check and set alignment
+//
+#define ASSERT_ALIGNED(addr, size) ASSERT (!((UINT32) (addr) & (size - 1)))
+#define IS_ALIGNED(addr, size) !((UINT32) (addr) & (size - 1))
+
+//
+// Define a macro to get the operand. Then we can change it to be either a
+// direct read or have it call a function to read memory.
+//
+#define GETOPERANDS(pVM) (UINT8) (*(UINT8 *) (pVM->Ip + 1))
+#define GETOPCODE(pVM) (UINT8) (*(UINT8 *) pVM->Ip)
+
+//
+// Bit masks for opcode encodings
+//
+#define OPCODE_M_OPCODE 0x3F // bits of interest for first level decode
+#define OPCODE_M_IMMDATA 0x80
+#define OPCODE_M_IMMDATA64 0x40
+#define OPCODE_M_64BIT 0x40 // for CMP
+#define OPCODE_M_RELADDR 0x10 // for CALL instruction
+#define OPCODE_M_CMPI32_DATA 0x80 // for CMPI
+#define OPCODE_M_CMPI64 0x40 // for CMPI 32 or 64 bit comparison
+#define OPERAND_M_MOVIN_N 0x80
+#define OPERAND_M_CMPI_INDEX 0x10
+
+//
+// Masks for instructions that encode presence of indexes for operand1 and/or
+// operand2.
+//
+#define OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP1 0x80
+#define OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2 0x40
+
+//
+// Bit masks for operand encodings
+//
+#define OPERAND_M_INDIRECT1 0x08
+#define OPERAND_M_INDIRECT2 0x80
+#define OPERAND_M_OP1 0x07
+#define OPERAND_M_OP2 0x70
+
+//
+// Masks for data manipulation instructions
+//
+#define DATAMANIP_M_64 0x40 // 64-bit width operation
+#define DATAMANIP_M_IMMDATA 0x80
+
+//
+// For MOV instructions, need a mask for the opcode when immediate
+// data applies to R2.
+//
+#define OPCODE_M_IMMED_OP2 0x40
+
+//
+// The MOVI/MOVIn instructions use bit 6 of operands byte to indicate
+// if an index is present. Then bits 4 and 5 are used to indicate the width
+// of the move.
+//
+#define MOVI_M_IMMDATA 0x40
+#define MOVI_M_DATAWIDTH 0xC0
+#define MOVI_DATAWIDTH16 0x40
+#define MOVI_DATAWIDTH32 0x80
+#define MOVI_DATAWIDTH64 0xC0
+#define MOVI_M_MOVEWIDTH 0x30
+#define MOVI_MOVEWIDTH8 0x00
+#define MOVI_MOVEWIDTH16 0x10
+#define MOVI_MOVEWIDTH32 0x20
+#define MOVI_MOVEWIDTH64 0x30
+
+//
+// Masks for CALL instruction encodings
+//
+#define OPERAND_M_RELATIVE_ADDR 0x10
+#define OPERAND_M_NATIVE_CALL 0x20
+
+//
+// Masks for decoding push/pop instructions
+//
+#define PUSHPOP_M_IMMDATA 0x80 // opcode bit indicating immediate data
+#define PUSHPOP_M_64 0x40 // opcode bit indicating 64-bit operation
+//
+// Mask for operand of JMP instruction
+//
+#define JMP_M_RELATIVE 0x10
+#define JMP_M_CONDITIONAL 0x80
+#define JMP_M_CS 0x40
+
+//
+// Macros to determine if a given operand is indirect
+//
+#define OPERAND1_INDIRECT(op) ((op) & OPERAND_M_INDIRECT1)
+#define OPERAND2_INDIRECT(op) ((op) & OPERAND_M_INDIRECT2)
+
+//
+// Macros to extract the operands from second byte of instructions
+//
+#define OPERAND1_REGNUM(op) ((op) & OPERAND_M_OP1)
+#define OPERAND2_REGNUM(op) (((op) & OPERAND_M_OP2) >> 4)
+
+#define OPERAND1_CHAR(op) ('0' + OPERAND1_REGNUM (op))
+#define OPERAND2_CHAR(op) ('0' + OPERAND2_REGNUM (op))
+
+#define OPERAND1_REGDATA(pvm, op) pvm->R[OPERAND1_REGNUM (op)]
+#define OPERAND2_REGDATA(pvm, op) pvm->R[OPERAND2_REGNUM (op)]
+
+//
+// Condition masks usually for byte 1 encodings of code
+//
+#define CONDITION_M_CONDITIONAL 0x80
+#define CONDITION_M_CS 0x40
+
+//
+// Bits in the VM->StopFlags field
+//
+#define STOPFLAG_APP_DONE 0x0001
+#define STOPFLAG_BREAKPOINT 0x0002
+#define STOPFLAG_INVALID_BREAK 0x0004
+#define STOPFLAG_BREAK_ON_CALLEX 0x0008
+
+//
+// Masks for working with the VM flags register
+//
+#define VMFLAGS_CC 0x0001 // condition flag
+#define VMFLAGS_STEP 0x0002 // step instruction mode
+#define VMFLAGS_ALL_VALID (VMFLAGS_CC | VMFLAGS_STEP)
+
+//
+// Macros for operating on the VM flags register
+//
+#define VMFLAG_SET(pVM, Flag) (pVM->Flags |= (Flag))
+#define VMFLAG_ISSET(pVM, Flag) ((pVM->Flags & (Flag)) ? 1 : 0)
+#define VMFLAG_CLEAR(pVM, Flag) (pVM->Flags &= ~(Flag))
+
+//
+// Debug macro
+//
+#define EBCMSG(s) gST->ConOut->OutputString (gST->ConOut, s)
+
+//
+// Define OPCODES
+//
+#define OPCODE_BREAK 0x00
+#define OPCODE_JMP 0x01
+#define OPCODE_JMP8 0x02
+#define OPCODE_CALL 0x03
+#define OPCODE_RET 0x04
+#define OPCODE_CMPEQ 0x05
+#define OPCODE_CMPLTE 0x06
+#define OPCODE_CMPGTE 0x07
+#define OPCODE_CMPULTE 0x08
+#define OPCODE_CMPUGTE 0x09
+#define OPCODE_NOT 0x0A
+#define OPCODE_NEG 0x0B
+#define OPCODE_ADD 0x0C
+#define OPCODE_SUB 0x0D
+#define OPCODE_MUL 0x0E
+#define OPCODE_MULU 0x0F
+#define OPCODE_DIV 0x10
+#define OPCODE_DIVU 0x11
+#define OPCODE_MOD 0x12
+#define OPCODE_MODU 0x13
+#define OPCODE_AND 0x14
+#define OPCODE_OR 0x15
+#define OPCODE_XOR 0x16
+#define OPCODE_SHL 0x17
+#define OPCODE_SHR 0x18
+#define OPCODE_ASHR 0x19
+#define OPCODE_EXTNDB 0x1A
+#define OPCODE_EXTNDW 0x1B
+#define OPCODE_EXTNDD 0x1C
+#define OPCODE_MOVBW 0x1D
+#define OPCODE_MOVWW 0x1E
+#define OPCODE_MOVDW 0x1F
+#define OPCODE_MOVQW 0x20
+#define OPCODE_MOVBD 0x21
+#define OPCODE_MOVWD 0x22
+#define OPCODE_MOVDD 0x23
+#define OPCODE_MOVQD 0x24
+#define OPCODE_MOVSNW 0x25 // Move signed natural with word index
+#define OPCODE_MOVSND 0x26 // Move signed natural with dword index
+//
+// #define OPCODE_27 0x27
+//
+#define OPCODE_MOVQQ 0x28 // Does this go away?
+#define OPCODE_LOADSP 0x29
+#define OPCODE_STORESP 0x2A
+#define OPCODE_PUSH 0x2B
+#define OPCODE_POP 0x2C
+#define OPCODE_CMPIEQ 0x2D
+#define OPCODE_CMPILTE 0x2E
+#define OPCODE_CMPIGTE 0x2F
+#define OPCODE_CMPIULTE 0x30
+#define OPCODE_CMPIUGTE 0x31
+#define OPCODE_MOVNW 0x32
+#define OPCODE_MOVND 0x33
+//
+// #define OPCODE_34 0x34
+//
+#define OPCODE_PUSHN 0x35
+#define OPCODE_POPN 0x36
+#define OPCODE_MOVI 0x37
+#define OPCODE_MOVIN 0x38
+#define OPCODE_MOVREL 0x39
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcExecute (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+;
+
+
+
+UINT64
+GetVmVersion (
+ VOID
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMemN (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINTN Data
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+VmWriteMem64 (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINTN Addr,
+ IN UINT64 Data
+ )
+;
+
+//
+// Define a protocol for an EBC VM test interface.
+//
+#define EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL_GUID \
+ { \
+ 0xAAEACCFDL, 0xF27B, 0x4C17, { 0xB6, 0x10, 0x75, 0xCA, 0x1F, 0x2D, 0xFB, 0x52 } \
+ }
+
+//
+// Define for forward reference.
+//
+typedef struct _EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL;
+
+typedef
+EFI_STATUS
+(*EBC_VM_TEST_EXECUTE) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr,
+ IN OUT UINTN *InstructionCount
+ );
+
+typedef
+EFI_STATUS
+(*EBC_VM_TEST_ASM) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN CHAR16 *AsmText,
+ IN OUT INT8 *Buffer,
+ IN OUT UINTN *BufferLen
+ );
+
+typedef
+EFI_STATUS
+(*EBC_VM_TEST_DASM) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN OUT CHAR16 *AsmText,
+ IN OUT INT8 *Buffer,
+ IN OUT UINTN *Len
+ );
+
+//
+// Prototype for the actual EBC test protocol interface
+//
+struct _EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL {
+ EBC_VM_TEST_EXECUTE Execute;
+ EBC_VM_TEST_ASM Assemble;
+ EBC_VM_TEST_DASM Disassemble;
+};
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcExecuteInstructions (
+ IN EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN OUT UINTN *InstructionCount
+ )
+;
+
+#endif // ifndef _EBC_EXECUTE_H_
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..2b647d9 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.c @@ -0,0 +1,1172 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcInt.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Top level module for the EBC virtual machine implementation.
+ Provides auxilliary support routines for the VM. That is, routines
+ that are not particularly related to VM execution of EBC instructions.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "EbcInt.h"
+#include "EbcExecute.h"
+
+//
+// We'll keep track of all thunks we create in a linked list. Each
+// thunk is tied to an image handle, so we have a linked list of
+// image handles, with each having a linked list of thunks allocated
+// to that image handle.
+//
+typedef struct _EBC_THUNK_LIST {
+ VOID *ThunkBuffer;
+ struct _EBC_THUNK_LIST *Next;
+} EBC_THUNK_LIST;
+
+typedef struct _EBC_IMAGE_LIST {
+ struct _EBC_IMAGE_LIST *Next;
+ EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle;
+ EBC_THUNK_LIST *ThunkList;
+} EBC_IMAGE_LIST;
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcUnloadImage (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcCreateThunk (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcGetVersion (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN OUT UINT64 *Version
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeEbcCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This
+ );
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+EFIAPI
+CommonEbcExceptionHandler (
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE InterruptType,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT SystemContext
+ );
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+EFIAPI
+EbcPeriodicNotifyFunction (
+ IN EFI_EVENT Event,
+ IN VOID *Context
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugPeriodic (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ );
+
+//
+// These two functions and the GUID are used to produce an EBC test protocol.
+// This functionality is definitely not required for execution.
+//
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+InitEbcVmTestProtocol (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE *Handle
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcVmTestUnsupported (
+ VOID
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcRegisterICacheFlush (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EBC_ICACHE_FLUSH Flush
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugGetMaximumProcessorIndex (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ OUT UINTN *MaxProcessorIndex
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugRegisterPeriodicCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN EFI_PERIODIC_CALLBACK PeriodicCallback
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugRegisterExceptionCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_CALLBACK ExceptionCallback,
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE ExceptionType
+ );
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugInvalidateInstructionCache (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN VOID *Start,
+ IN UINT64 Length
+ );
+
+//
+// We have one linked list of image handles for the whole world. Since
+// there should only be one interpreter, make them global. They must
+// also be global since the execution of an EBC image does not provide
+// a This pointer.
+//
+static EBC_IMAGE_LIST *mEbcImageList = NULL;
+
+//
+// Callback function to flush the icache after thunk creation
+//
+static EBC_ICACHE_FLUSH mEbcICacheFlush;
+
+//
+// These get set via calls by the debug agent
+//
+static EFI_PERIODIC_CALLBACK mDebugPeriodicCallback = NULL;
+static EFI_EXCEPTION_CALLBACK mDebugExceptionCallback[MAX_EBC_EXCEPTION + 1] = {NULL};
+static EFI_GUID mEfiEbcVmTestProtocolGuid = EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL_GUID;
+
+static VOID* mStackBuffer[MAX_STACK_NUM];
+static EFI_HANDLE mStackBufferIndex[MAX_STACK_NUM];
+static UINTN mStackNum = 0;
+
+//
+// Event for Periodic callback
+//
+static EFI_EVENT mEbcPeriodicEvent;
+VM_CONTEXT *mVmPtr = NULL;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeEbcDriver (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Initializes the VM EFI interface. Allocates memory for the VM interface
+ and registers the VM protocol.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - EFI image handle.
+ SystemTable - Pointer to the EFI system table.
+
+Returns:
+ Standard EFI status code.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *EbcProtocol;
+ EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *OldEbcProtocol;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *EbcDebugProtocol;
+ EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
+ UINTN NumHandles;
+ UINTN Index;
+ BOOLEAN Installed;
+
+ EbcProtocol = NULL;
+ EbcDebugProtocol = NULL;
+
+ //
+ // Allocate memory for our protocol. Then fill in the blanks.
+ //
+ EbcProtocol = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL));
+
+ if (EbcProtocol == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ EbcProtocol->CreateThunk = EbcCreateThunk;
+ EbcProtocol->UnloadImage = EbcUnloadImage;
+ EbcProtocol->RegisterICacheFlush = EbcRegisterICacheFlush;
+ EbcProtocol->GetVersion = EbcGetVersion;
+ mEbcICacheFlush = NULL;
+
+ //
+ // Find any already-installed EBC protocols and uninstall them
+ //
+ Installed = FALSE;
+ HandleBuffer = NULL;
+ Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
+ ByProtocol,
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ NULL,
+ &NumHandles,
+ &HandleBuffer
+ );
+ if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ //
+ // Loop through the handles
+ //
+ for (Index = 0; Index < NumHandles; Index++) {
+ Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ (VOID **) &OldEbcProtocol
+ );
+ if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ if (gBS->ReinstallProtocolInterface (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ OldEbcProtocol,
+ EbcProtocol
+ ) == EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ Installed = TRUE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
+ FreePool (HandleBuffer);
+ HandleBuffer = NULL;
+ }
+ //
+ // Add the protocol so someone can locate us if we haven't already.
+ //
+ if (!Installed) {
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (
+ &ImageHandle,
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
+ EbcProtocol
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (EbcProtocol);
+ return Status;
+ }
+ }
+
+ Status = InitEBCStack();
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ goto ErrorExit;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Allocate memory for our debug protocol. Then fill in the blanks.
+ //
+ EbcDebugProtocol = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL));
+
+ if (EbcDebugProtocol == NULL) {
+ goto ErrorExit;
+ }
+
+ EbcDebugProtocol->Isa = IsaEbc;
+ EbcDebugProtocol->GetMaximumProcessorIndex = EbcDebugGetMaximumProcessorIndex;
+ EbcDebugProtocol->RegisterPeriodicCallback = EbcDebugRegisterPeriodicCallback;
+ EbcDebugProtocol->RegisterExceptionCallback = EbcDebugRegisterExceptionCallback;
+ EbcDebugProtocol->InvalidateInstructionCache = EbcDebugInvalidateInstructionCache;
+
+ //
+ // Add the protocol so the debug agent can find us
+ //
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (
+ &ImageHandle,
+ &gEfiDebugSupportProtocolGuid,
+ EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
+ EbcDebugProtocol
+ );
+ //
+ // This is recoverable, so free the memory and continue.
+ //
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (EbcDebugProtocol);
+ goto ErrorExit;
+ }
+ //
+ // Install EbcDebugSupport Protocol Successfully
+ // Now we need to initialize the Ebc default Callback
+ //
+ Status = InitializeEbcCallback (EbcDebugProtocol);
+
+ //
+ // Produce a VM test interface protocol. Not required for execution.
+ //
+ DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN ();
+ InitEbcVmTestProtocol (&ImageHandle);
+ DEBUG_CODE_END ();
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+
+ErrorExit:
+ FreeEBCStack();
+ HandleBuffer = NULL;
+ Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
+ ByProtocol,
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ NULL,
+ &NumHandles,
+ &HandleBuffer
+ );
+ if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ //
+ // Loop through the handles
+ //
+ for (Index = 0; Index < NumHandles; Index++) {
+ Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ (VOID **) &OldEbcProtocol
+ );
+ if (Status == EFI_SUCCESS) {
+ gBS->UninstallProtocolInterface (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiEbcProtocolGuid,
+ OldEbcProtocol
+ );
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (HandleBuffer != NULL) {
+ FreePool (HandleBuffer);
+ HandleBuffer = NULL;
+ }
+
+ FreePool (EbcProtocol);
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcCreateThunk (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This is the top-level routine plugged into the EBC protocol. Since thunks
+ are very processor-specific, from here we dispatch directly to the very
+ processor-specific routine EbcCreateThunks().
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - protocol instance pointer
+ ImageHandle - handle to the image. The EBC interpreter may use this to keep
+ track of any resource allocations performed in loading and
+ executing the image.
+ EbcEntryPoint - the entry point for the image (as defined in the file header)
+ Thunk - pointer to thunk pointer where the address of the created
+ thunk is returned.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_STATUS
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ Status = EbcCreateThunks (
+ ImageHandle,
+ EbcEntryPoint,
+ Thunk,
+ FLAG_THUNK_ENTRY_POINT
+ );
+ return Status;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugGetMaximumProcessorIndex (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ OUT UINTN *MaxProcessorIndex
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This EBC debugger protocol service is called by the debug agent
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - pointer to the caller's debug support protocol interface
+ MaxProcessorIndex - pointer to a caller allocated UINTN in which the maximum
+ processor index is returned.
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI_STATUS
+
+--*/
+{
+ *MaxProcessorIndex = 0;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugRegisterPeriodicCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN EFI_PERIODIC_CALLBACK PeriodicCallback
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This protocol service is called by the debug agent to register a function
+ for us to call on a periodic basis.
+
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - pointer to the caller's debug support protocol interface
+ PeriodicCallback - pointer to the function to call periodically
+
+Returns:
+
+ Always EFI_SUCCESS
+
+--*/
+{
+ if ((mDebugPeriodicCallback == NULL) && (PeriodicCallback == NULL)) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ if ((mDebugPeriodicCallback != NULL) && (PeriodicCallback != NULL)) {
+ return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
+ }
+
+ mDebugPeriodicCallback = PeriodicCallback;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugRegisterExceptionCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_CALLBACK ExceptionCallback,
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE ExceptionType
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This protocol service is called by the debug agent to register a function
+ for us to call when we detect an exception.
+
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - pointer to the caller's debug support protocol interface
+ ExceptionCallback - pointer to the function to the exception
+
+Returns:
+
+ Always EFI_SUCCESS
+
+--*/
+{
+ if ((ExceptionType < 0) || (ExceptionType > MAX_EBC_EXCEPTION)) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ if ((mDebugExceptionCallback[ExceptionType] == NULL) && (ExceptionCallback == NULL)) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ if ((mDebugExceptionCallback[ExceptionType] != NULL) && (ExceptionCallback != NULL)) {
+ return EFI_ALREADY_STARTED;
+ }
+ mDebugExceptionCallback[ExceptionType] = ExceptionCallback;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcDebugInvalidateInstructionCache (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN UINTN ProcessorIndex,
+ IN VOID *Start,
+ IN UINT64 Length
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This EBC debugger protocol service is called by the debug agent. Required
+ for DebugSupport compliance but is only stubbed out for EBC.
+
+Arguments:
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcDebugSignalException (
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE ExceptionType,
+ IN EXCEPTION_FLAGS ExceptionFlags,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The VM interpreter calls this function when an exception is detected.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context for passing info to the EFI debugger.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS if it returns at all
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT_EBC EbcContext;
+ EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT SystemContext;
+
+ ASSERT ((ExceptionType >= 0) && (ExceptionType <= MAX_EBC_EXCEPTION));
+ //
+ // Save the exception in the context passed in
+ //
+ VmPtr->ExceptionFlags |= ExceptionFlags;
+ VmPtr->LastException = ExceptionType;
+ //
+ // If it's a fatal exception, then flag it in the VM context in case an
+ // attached debugger tries to return from it.
+ //
+ if (ExceptionFlags & EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL) {
+ VmPtr->StopFlags |= STOPFLAG_APP_DONE;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // If someone's registered for exception callbacks, then call them.
+ //
+ // EBC driver will register default exception callback to report the
+ // status code via the status code API
+ //
+ if (mDebugExceptionCallback[ExceptionType] != NULL) {
+
+ //
+ // Initialize the context structure
+ //
+ EbcContext.R0 = VmPtr->R[0];
+ EbcContext.R1 = VmPtr->R[1];
+ EbcContext.R2 = VmPtr->R[2];
+ EbcContext.R3 = VmPtr->R[3];
+ EbcContext.R4 = VmPtr->R[4];
+ EbcContext.R5 = VmPtr->R[5];
+ EbcContext.R6 = VmPtr->R[6];
+ EbcContext.R7 = VmPtr->R[7];
+ EbcContext.Ip = (UINT64)(UINTN)VmPtr->Ip;
+ EbcContext.Flags = VmPtr->Flags;
+ EbcContext.ControlFlags = 0;
+ SystemContext.SystemContextEbc = &EbcContext;
+
+ mDebugExceptionCallback[ExceptionType] (ExceptionType, SystemContext);
+ //
+ // Restore the context structure and continue to execute
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] = EbcContext.R0;
+ VmPtr->R[1] = EbcContext.R1;
+ VmPtr->R[2] = EbcContext.R2;
+ VmPtr->R[3] = EbcContext.R3;
+ VmPtr->R[4] = EbcContext.R4;
+ VmPtr->R[5] = EbcContext.R5;
+ VmPtr->R[6] = EbcContext.R6;
+ VmPtr->R[7] = EbcContext.R7;
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP)(UINTN)EbcContext.Ip;
+ VmPtr->Flags = EbcContext.Flags;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+InitializeEbcCallback (
+ IN EFI_DEBUG_SUPPORT_PROTOCOL *This
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ To install default Callback function for the VM interpreter.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - pointer to the instance of DebugSupport protocol
+
+Returns:
+
+ None
+
+--*/
+{
+ INTN Index;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // For ExceptionCallback
+ //
+ for (Index = 0; Index <= MAX_EBC_EXCEPTION; Index++) {
+ EbcDebugRegisterExceptionCallback (
+ This,
+ 0,
+ CommonEbcExceptionHandler,
+ Index
+ );
+ }
+
+ //
+ // For PeriodicCallback
+ //
+ Status = gBS->CreateEvent (
+ EVT_TIMER | EVT_NOTIFY_SIGNAL,
+ TPL_NOTIFY,
+ EbcPeriodicNotifyFunction,
+ &mVmPtr,
+ &mEbcPeriodicEvent
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Status = gBS->SetTimer (
+ mEbcPeriodicEvent,
+ TimerPeriodic,
+ EBC_VM_PERIODIC_CALLBACK_RATE
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+CommonEbcExceptionHandler (
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE InterruptType,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT SystemContext
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The default Exception Callback for the VM interpreter.
+ In this function, we report status code, and print debug information
+ about EBC_CONTEXT, then dead loop.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ InterruptType - Interrupt type.
+ SystemContext - EBC system context.
+
+Returns:
+
+ None
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // We deadloop here to make it easy to debug this issue.
+ //
+ ASSERT (FALSE);
+
+ return ;
+}
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+EFIAPI
+EbcPeriodicNotifyFunction (
+ IN EFI_EVENT Event,
+ IN VOID *Context
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The periodic callback function for EBC VM interpreter, which is used
+ to support the EFI debug support protocol.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Event - The Periodic Callback Event.
+ Context - It should be the address of VM_CONTEXT pointer.
+
+Returns:
+
+ None.
+
+--*/
+{
+ VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr;
+
+ VmPtr = *(VM_CONTEXT **)Context;
+
+ if (VmPtr != NULL) {
+ EbcDebugPeriodic (VmPtr);
+ }
+
+ return ;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcDebugPeriodic (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The VM interpreter calls this function on a periodic basis to support
+ the EFI debug support protocol.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - pointer to a VM context for passing info to the debugger.
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI status.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT_EBC EbcContext;
+ EFI_SYSTEM_CONTEXT SystemContext;
+
+ //
+ // If someone's registered for periodic callbacks, then call them.
+ //
+ if (mDebugPeriodicCallback != NULL) {
+
+ //
+ // Initialize the context structure
+ //
+ EbcContext.R0 = VmPtr->R[0];
+ EbcContext.R1 = VmPtr->R[1];
+ EbcContext.R2 = VmPtr->R[2];
+ EbcContext.R3 = VmPtr->R[3];
+ EbcContext.R4 = VmPtr->R[4];
+ EbcContext.R5 = VmPtr->R[5];
+ EbcContext.R6 = VmPtr->R[6];
+ EbcContext.R7 = VmPtr->R[7];
+ EbcContext.Ip = (UINT64)(UINTN)VmPtr->Ip;
+ EbcContext.Flags = VmPtr->Flags;
+ EbcContext.ControlFlags = 0;
+ SystemContext.SystemContextEbc = &EbcContext;
+
+ mDebugPeriodicCallback (SystemContext);
+
+ //
+ // Restore the context structure and continue to execute
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] = EbcContext.R0;
+ VmPtr->R[1] = EbcContext.R1;
+ VmPtr->R[2] = EbcContext.R2;
+ VmPtr->R[3] = EbcContext.R3;
+ VmPtr->R[4] = EbcContext.R4;
+ VmPtr->R[5] = EbcContext.R5;
+ VmPtr->R[6] = EbcContext.R6;
+ VmPtr->R[7] = EbcContext.R7;
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP)(UINTN)EbcContext.Ip;
+ VmPtr->Flags = EbcContext.Flags;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcUnloadImage (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This routine is called by the core when an image is being unloaded from
+ memory. Basically we now have the opportunity to do any necessary cleanup.
+ Typically this will include freeing any memory allocated for thunk-creation.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - protocol instance pointer
+ ImageHandle - handle to the image being unloaded.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - the ImageHandle passed in was not found in
+ the internal list of EBC image handles.
+ EFI_STATUS - completed successfully
+
+--*/
+{
+ EBC_THUNK_LIST *ThunkList;
+ EBC_THUNK_LIST *NextThunkList;
+ EBC_IMAGE_LIST *ImageList;
+ EBC_IMAGE_LIST *PrevImageList;
+ //
+ // First go through our list of known image handles and see if we've already
+ // created an image list element for this image handle.
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStackByHandle(ImageHandle);
+ PrevImageList = NULL;
+ for (ImageList = mEbcImageList; ImageList != NULL; ImageList = ImageList->Next) {
+ if (ImageList->ImageHandle == ImageHandle) {
+ break;
+ }
+ //
+ // Save the previous so we can connect the lists when we remove this one
+ //
+ PrevImageList = ImageList;
+ }
+
+ if (ImageList == NULL) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ //
+ // Free up all the thunk buffers and thunks list elements for this image
+ // handle.
+ //
+ ThunkList = ImageList->ThunkList;
+ while (ThunkList != NULL) {
+ NextThunkList = ThunkList->Next;
+ FreePool (ThunkList->ThunkBuffer);
+ FreePool (ThunkList);
+ ThunkList = NextThunkList;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now remove this image list element from the chain
+ //
+ if (PrevImageList == NULL) {
+ //
+ // Remove from head
+ //
+ mEbcImageList = ImageList->Next;
+ } else {
+ PrevImageList->Next = ImageList->Next;
+ }
+ //
+ // Now free up the image list element
+ //
+ FreePool (ImageList);
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcAddImageThunk (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *ThunkBuffer,
+ IN UINT32 ThunkSize
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Add a thunk to our list of thunks for a given image handle.
+ Also flush the instruction cache since we've written thunk code
+ to memory that will be executed eventually.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - the image handle to which the thunk is tied
+ ThunkBuffer - the buffer we've created/allocated
+ ThunkSize - the size of the thunk memory allocated
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - memory allocation failed
+ EFI_SUCCESS - successful completion
+
+--*/
+{
+ EBC_THUNK_LIST *ThunkList;
+ EBC_IMAGE_LIST *ImageList;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // It so far so good, then flush the instruction cache
+ //
+ if (mEbcICacheFlush != NULL) {
+ Status = mEbcICacheFlush ((EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) (UINTN) ThunkBuffer, ThunkSize);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Go through our list of known image handles and see if we've already
+ // created a image list element for this image handle.
+ //
+ for (ImageList = mEbcImageList; ImageList != NULL; ImageList = ImageList->Next) {
+ if (ImageList->ImageHandle == ImageHandle) {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (ImageList == NULL) {
+ //
+ // Allocate a new one
+ //
+ ImageList = AllocatePool (sizeof (EBC_IMAGE_LIST));
+
+ if (ImageList == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ ImageList->ThunkList = NULL;
+ ImageList->ImageHandle = ImageHandle;
+ ImageList->Next = mEbcImageList;
+ mEbcImageList = ImageList;
+ }
+ //
+ // Ok, now create a new thunk element to add to the list
+ //
+ ThunkList = AllocatePool (sizeof (EBC_THUNK_LIST));
+
+ if (ThunkList == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Add it to the head of the list
+ //
+ ThunkList->Next = ImageList->ThunkList;
+ ThunkList->ThunkBuffer = ThunkBuffer;
+ ImageList->ThunkList = ThunkList;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcRegisterICacheFlush (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EBC_ICACHE_FLUSH Flush
+ )
+{
+ mEbcICacheFlush = Flush;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+EbcGetVersion (
+ IN EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN OUT UINT64 *Version
+ )
+{
+ if (Version == NULL) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ *Version = GetVmVersion ();
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+GetEBCStack(
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle,
+ VOID **StackBuffer,
+ UINTN *BufferIndex
+ )
+{
+ UINTN Index;
+ EFI_TPL OldTpl;
+ OldTpl = gBS->RaiseTPL(TPL_HIGH_LEVEL);
+ for (Index = 0; Index < mStackNum; Index ++) {
+ if (mStackBufferIndex[Index] == NULL) {
+ mStackBufferIndex[Index] = Handle;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ gBS->RestoreTPL(OldTpl);
+ if (Index == mStackNum) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ *BufferIndex = Index;
+ *StackBuffer = mStackBuffer[Index];
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+ReturnEBCStack(
+ UINTN Index
+ )
+{
+ mStackBufferIndex[Index] =NULL;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+ReturnEBCStackByHandle(
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle
+ )
+{
+ UINTN Index;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < mStackNum; Index ++) {
+ if (mStackBufferIndex[Index] == Handle) {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (Index == mStackNum) {
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ }
+ mStackBufferIndex[Index] = NULL;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+InitEBCStack (
+ VOID
+ )
+{
+ for (mStackNum = 0; mStackNum < MAX_STACK_NUM; mStackNum ++) {
+ mStackBuffer[mStackNum] = AllocatePool(STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ mStackBufferIndex[mStackNum] = NULL;
+ if (mStackBuffer[mStackNum] == NULL) {
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (mStackNum == 0) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FreeEBCStack(
+ VOID
+ )
+{
+ UINTN Index;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < mStackNum; Index ++) {
+ FreePool(mStackBuffer[Index]);
+ }
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+InitEbcVmTestProtocol (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE *IHandle
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Produce an EBC VM test protocol that can be used for regression tests.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ IHandle - handle on which to install the protocol.
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - memory allocation failed
+ EFI_SUCCESS - successful completion
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL *EbcVmTestProtocol;
+
+ //
+ // Allocate memory for the protocol, then fill in the fields
+ //
+ EbcVmTestProtocol = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_EBC_VM_TEST_PROTOCOL));
+ if (EbcVmTestProtocol == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ EbcVmTestProtocol->Execute = (EBC_VM_TEST_EXECUTE) EbcExecuteInstructions;
+
+ DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN ();
+ EbcVmTestProtocol->Assemble = (EBC_VM_TEST_ASM) EbcVmTestUnsupported;
+ EbcVmTestProtocol->Disassemble = (EBC_VM_TEST_DASM) EbcVmTestUnsupported;
+ DEBUG_CODE_END ();
+
+ //
+ // Publish the protocol
+ //
+ Handle = NULL;
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (&Handle, &mEfiEbcVmTestProtocolGuid, EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE, EbcVmTestProtocol);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (EbcVmTestProtocol);
+ }
+ return Status;
+}
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcVmTestUnsupported ()
+{
+ return EFI_UNSUPPORTED;
+}
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d1631f8 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/EbcInt.h @@ -0,0 +1,283 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcInt.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Main routines for the EBC interpreter. Includes the initialization and
+ main interpreter routines.
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _EBC_INT_H_
+#define _EBC_INT_H_
+
+//
+// The package level header files this module uses
+//
+#include <PiDxe.h>
+//
+// The protocols, PPI and GUID defintions for this module
+//
+#include <Protocol/DebugSupport.h>
+#include <Protocol/Ebc.h>
+//
+// The Library classes this module consumes
+//
+#include <Library/BaseLib.h>
+#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiDriverEntryPoint.h>
+#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
+#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
+
+typedef INT64 VM_REGISTER;
+typedef UINT8 *VMIP; // instruction pointer for the VM
+typedef UINT32 EXCEPTION_FLAGS;
+
+typedef struct {
+ VM_REGISTER R[8]; // General purpose registers.
+ UINT64 Flags; // Flags register:
+ // 0 Set to 1 if the result of the last compare was true
+ // 1 Set to 1 if stepping
+ // 2..63 Reserved.
+ VMIP Ip; // Instruction pointer.
+ UINTN LastException; //
+ EXCEPTION_FLAGS ExceptionFlags; // to keep track of exceptions
+ UINT32 StopFlags;
+ UINT32 CompilerVersion; // via break(6)
+ UINTN HighStackBottom; // bottom of the upper stack
+ UINTN LowStackTop; // top of the lower stack
+ UINT64 StackRetAddr; // location of final return address on stack
+ UINTN *StackMagicPtr; // pointer to magic value on stack to detect corruption
+ EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle; // for this EBC driver
+ EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable; // for debugging only
+ UINTN LastAddrConverted; // for debug
+ UINTN LastAddrConvertedValue; // for debug
+ VOID *FramePtr;
+ VOID *EntryPoint; // entry point of EBC image
+ UINTN ImageBase;
+ VOID *StackPool;
+ VOID *StackTop;
+} VM_CONTEXT;
+
+extern VM_CONTEXT *mVmPtr;
+
+//
+// Bits of exception flags field of VM context
+//
+#define EXCEPTION_FLAG_FATAL 0x80000000 // can't continue
+#define EXCEPTION_FLAG_ERROR 0x40000000 // bad, but try to continue
+#define EXCEPTION_FLAG_WARNING 0x20000000 // harmless problem
+#define EXCEPTION_FLAG_NONE 0x00000000 // for normal return
+//
+// Flags passed to the internal create-thunks function.
+//
+#define FLAG_THUNK_ENTRY_POINT 0x01 // thunk for an image entry point
+#define FLAG_THUNK_PROTOCOL 0x00 // thunk for an EBC protocol service
+//
+// Put this value at the bottom of the VM's stack gap so we can check it on
+// occasion to make sure the stack has not been corrupted.
+//
+#define VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE 0xDEADBEEF
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcCreateThunks (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk,
+ IN UINT32 Flags
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcAddImageThunk (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *ThunkBuffer,
+ IN UINT32 ThunkSize
+ )
+;
+
+//
+// The interpreter calls these when an exception is detected,
+// or as a periodic callback.
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcDebugSignalException (
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE ExceptionType,
+ IN EXCEPTION_FLAGS ExceptionFlags,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+;
+
+//
+// Define a constant of how often to call the debugger periodic callback
+// function.
+//
+#define EFI_TIMER_UNIT_1MS (1000 * 10)
+#define EBC_VM_PERIODIC_CALLBACK_RATE (1000 * EFI_TIMER_UNIT_1MS)
+#define STACK_POOL_SIZE (1024 * 1020)
+#define MAX_STACK_NUM 4
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcDebugSignalPeriodic (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr
+ )
+;
+
+//
+// External low level functions that are native-processor dependent
+//
+UINTN
+EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint (
+ VOID
+ )
+;
+
+UINTN
+EbcLLGetStackPointer (
+ VOID
+ )
+;
+
+VOID
+EbcLLCALLEXNative (
+ IN UINTN CallAddr,
+ IN UINTN EbcSp,
+ IN VOID *FramePtr
+ )
+;
+
+VOID
+EbcLLCALLEX (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN CallAddr,
+ IN UINTN EbcSp,
+ IN VOID *FramePtr,
+ IN UINT8 Size
+ )
+;
+
+INT64
+EbcLLGetReturnValue (
+ VOID
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+GetEBCStack(
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle,
+ VOID **StackBuffer,
+ UINTN *BufferIndex
+ );
+
+EFI_STATUS
+ReturnEBCStack(
+ UINTN Index
+ );
+
+EFI_STATUS
+InitEBCStack (
+ VOID
+ );
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FreeEBCStack(
+ VOID
+ );
+
+EFI_STATUS
+ReturnEBCStackByHandle(
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle
+ );
+//
+// Defines for a simple EBC debugger interface
+//
+typedef struct _EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL;
+
+#define EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL_GUID \
+ { \
+ 0x2a72d11e, 0x7376, 0x40f6, { 0x9c, 0x68, 0x23, 0xfa, 0x2f, 0xe3, 0x63, 0xf1 } \
+ }
+
+typedef
+EFI_STATUS
+(*EBC_DEBUGGER_SIGNAL_EXCEPTION) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr,
+ IN EFI_EXCEPTION_TYPE ExceptionType
+ );
+
+typedef
+VOID
+(*EBC_DEBUGGER_DEBUG) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr
+ );
+
+typedef
+UINT32
+(*EBC_DEBUGGER_DASM) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN VM_CONTEXT * VmPtr,
+ IN UINT16 *DasmString OPTIONAL,
+ IN UINT32 DasmStringSize
+ );
+
+//
+// This interface allows you to configure the EBC debug support
+// driver. For example, turn on or off saving and printing of
+// delta VM even if called. Or to even disable the entire interface,
+// in which case all functions become no-ops.
+//
+typedef
+EFI_STATUS
+(*EBC_DEBUGGER_CONFIGURE) (
+ IN EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL * This,
+ IN UINT32 ConfigId,
+ IN UINTN ConfigValue
+ );
+
+//
+// Prototype for the actual EBC debug support protocol interface
+//
+struct _EFI_EBC_SIMPLE_DEBUGGER_PROTOCOL {
+ EBC_DEBUGGER_DEBUG Debugger;
+ EBC_DEBUGGER_SIGNAL_EXCEPTION SignalException;
+ EBC_DEBUGGER_DASM Dasm;
+ EBC_DEBUGGER_CONFIGURE Configure;
+};
+
+typedef struct {
+ EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL *This;
+ VOID *EntryPoint;
+ EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle;
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+} EFI_EBC_THUNK_DATA;
+
+#define EBC_PROTOCOL_PRIVATE_DATA_SIGNATURE EFI_SIGNATURE_32 ('e', 'b', 'c', 'p')
+
+struct _EBC_PROTOCOL_PRIVATE_DATA {
+ UINT32 Signature;
+ EFI_EBC_PROTOCOL EbcProtocol;
+ UINTN StackBase;
+ UINTN StackTop;
+ UINTN StackSize;
+} ;
+
+#define EBC_PROTOCOL_PRIVATE_DATA_FROM_THIS(a) \
+ CR(a, EBC_PROTOCOL_PRIVATE_DATA, EbcProtocol, EBC_PROTOCOL_PRIVATE_DATA_SIGNATURE)
+
+
+#endif // #ifndef _EBC_INT_H_
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.S b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000..5e9828d --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.S @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +#****************************************************************************
+#*
+#* Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+#* All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+#* are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+#* which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+#* http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+#*
+#* THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+#* WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#*
+#****************************************************************************
+.globl ASM_PFX(CopyMem)
+
+.globl ASM_PFX(EbcLLCALLEXNative)
+ASM_PFX(EbcLLCALLEXNative):
+ push %ebp
+ push %ebx
+ mov %esp,%ebp
+ mov 0xc(%esp),%ecx
+ mov 0x14(%esp),%eax
+ mov 0x10(%esp),%edx
+ sub %edx,%eax
+ sub %eax,%esp
+ mov %esp,%ebx
+ push %ecx
+ push %eax
+ push %edx
+ push %ebx
+ call ASM_PFX(CopyMem)
+ pop %eax
+ pop %eax
+ pop %eax
+ pop %ecx
+ call *%ecx
+ mov %ebp,%esp
+ mov %ebp,%esp
+ pop %ebx
+ pop %ebp
+ ret
+
+.globl ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint)
+ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint):
+ ret
+
+.globl ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetStackPointer)
+ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetStackPointer):
+ mov %esp,%eax
+ add $0x4,%eax
+ ret
+
+.globl ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetReturnValue)
+ASM_PFX(EbcLLGetReturnValue):
+ ret
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.asm b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.asm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..4249241 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcLowLevel.asm @@ -0,0 +1,163 @@ + page ,132
+ title VM ASSEMBLY LANGUAGE ROUTINES
+;****************************************************************************
+;*
+;* Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+;* All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+;* are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+;* which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+;* http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+;*
+;* THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+;* WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+;*
+;****************************************************************************
+;****************************************************************************
+; REV 1.0
+;****************************************************************************
+;
+; Rev Date Description
+; --- -------- ------------------------------------------------------------
+; 1.0 03/14/01 Initial creation of file.
+;
+;****************************************************************************
+
+;* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+; This code provides low level routines that support the Virtual Machine
+; for option ROMs.
+;* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+; Equate files needed.
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+.XLIST
+
+.LIST
+
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+; Assembler options
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+.686p
+.model flat
+.code
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+;;GenericPostSegment SEGMENT USE16
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+CopyMem PROTO C Destination:PTR DWORD, Source:PTR DWORD, Count:DWORD
+
+;****************************************************************************
+; EbcLLCALLEXNative
+;
+; This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction
+; to native code.
+; This instruction requires that we thunk out to external native
+; code. For IA32, we simply switch stacks and jump to the
+; specified function. On return, we restore the stack pointer
+; to its original location.
+;
+; Destroys no working registers.
+;****************************************************************************
+; VOID EbcLLCALLEXNative(UINTN FuncAddr, UINTN NewStackPointer, VOID *FramePtr)
+_EbcLLCALLEXNative PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ push ebp
+ push ebx
+ mov ebp, esp ; standard function prolog
+
+ ; Get function address in a register
+ ; mov ecx, FuncAddr => mov ecx, dword ptr [FuncAddr]
+ mov ecx, dword ptr [esp]+0Ch
+
+ ; Set stack pointer to new value
+ ; mov eax, NewStackPointer => mov eax, dword ptr [NewSp]
+ mov eax, dword ptr [esp] + 14h
+ mov edx, dword ptr [esp] + 10h
+ sub eax, edx
+ sub esp, eax
+ mov ebx, esp
+ push ecx
+ push eax
+ push edx
+ push ebx
+ call CopyMem
+ pop eax
+ pop eax
+ pop eax
+ pop ecx
+
+ ; Now call the external routine
+ call ecx
+
+ ; ebp is preserved by the callee. In this function it
+ ; equals the original esp, so set them equal
+ mov esp, ebp
+
+ ; Standard function epilog
+ mov esp, ebp
+ pop ebx
+ pop ebp
+ ret
+_EbcLLCALLEXNative ENDP
+
+
+; UINTN EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint(VOID);
+; Routine Description:
+; The VM thunk code stuffs an EBC entry point into a processor
+; register. Since we can't use inline assembly to get it from
+; the interpreter C code, stuff it into the return value
+; register and return.
+;
+; Arguments:
+; None.
+;
+; Returns:
+; The contents of the register in which the entry point is passed.
+;
+_EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ ret
+_EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ENDP
+
+;/*++
+;
+;Routine Description:
+;
+; Return the caller's value of the stack pointer.
+;
+;Arguments:
+;
+; None.
+;
+;Returns:
+;
+; The current value of the stack pointer for the caller. We
+; adjust it by 4 here because when they called us, the return address
+; is put on the stack, thereby lowering it by 4 bytes.
+;
+;--*/
+
+; UINTN EbcLLGetStackPointer()
+_EbcLLGetStackPointer PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ mov eax, esp ; get current stack pointer
+ add eax, 4 ; stack adjusted by this much when we were called
+ ret
+_EbcLLGetStackPointer ENDP
+
+; UINT64 EbcLLGetReturnValue(VOID);
+; Routine Description:
+; When EBC calls native, on return the VM has to stuff the return
+; value into a VM register. It's assumed here that the value is still
+; in the register, so simply return and the caller should get the
+; return result properly.
+;
+; Arguments:
+; None.
+;
+; Returns:
+; The unmodified value returned by the native code.
+;
+_EbcLLGetReturnValue PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ ret
+_EbcLLGetReturnValue ENDP
+
+END
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcSupport.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcSupport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a534e00 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ia32/EbcSupport.c @@ -0,0 +1,545 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcSupport.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ This module contains EBC support routines that are customized based on
+ the target processor.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "EbcInt.h"
+#include "EbcExecute.h"
+
+//
+// NOTE: This is the stack size allocated for the interpreter
+// when it executes an EBC image. The requirements can change
+// based on whether or not a debugger is present, and other
+// platform-specific configurations.
+//
+#define VM_STACK_SIZE (1024 * 4)
+#define EBC_THUNK_SIZE 32
+
+#define STACK_REMAIN_SIZE (1024 * 4)
+VOID
+EbcLLCALLEX (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN FuncAddr,
+ IN UINTN NewStackPointer,
+ IN VOID *FramePtr,
+ IN UINT8 Size
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction.
+ The function check the callee's content to see whether it is common native
+ code or a thunk to another piece of EBC code.
+ If the callee is common native code, use EbcLLCAllEXASM to manipulate,
+ otherwise, set the VM->IP to target EBC code directly to avoid another VM
+ be startup which cost time and stack space.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - Pointer to a VM context.
+ FuncAddr - Callee's address
+ NewStackPointer - New stack pointer after the call
+ FramePtr - New frame pointer after the call
+ Size - The size of call instruction
+
+Returns:
+
+ None.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN IsThunk;
+ UINTN TargetEbcAddr;
+
+ IsThunk = 1;
+ TargetEbcAddr = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Processor specific code to check whether the callee is a thunk to EBC.
+ //
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr) != 0xB8) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 1) != 0xBC) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 2) != 0x2E) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 3) != 0x11) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 4) != 0xCA) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 5) != 0xB8) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 10) != 0xB9) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 15) != 0xFF) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 16) != 0xE1) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+
+ TargetEbcAddr = ((UINTN)(*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 9)) << 24) + ((UINTN)(*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 8)) << 16) +
+ ((UINTN)(*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 7)) << 8) + ((UINTN)(*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 6)));
+
+Action:
+ if (IsThunk == 1){
+ //
+ // The callee is a thunk to EBC, adjust the stack pointer down 16 bytes and
+ // put our return address and frame pointer on the VM stack.
+ // Then set the VM's IP to new EBC code.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINTN) FramePtr);
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0];
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINT64) (UINTN) (VmPtr->Ip + Size));
+
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) TargetEbcAddr;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // The callee is not a thunk to EBC, call native code.
+ //
+ EbcLLCALLEXNative (FuncAddr, NewStackPointer, FramePtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get return value and advance the IP.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[7] = EbcLLGetReturnValue ();
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+EbcInterpret (
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg1,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg2,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg3,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg4,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg5,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg6,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg7,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg8,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg9,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg10,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg11,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg12,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg13,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg14,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg15,
+ IN OUT UINTN Arg16
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Begin executing an EBC image. The address of the entry point is passed
+ in via a processor register, so we'll need to make a call to get the
+ value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ None. Since we're called from a fixed up thunk (which we want to keep
+ small), our only so-called argument is the EBC entry point passed in
+ to us in a processor register.
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value returned by the EBC application we're going to run.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+ //
+ // Initialize the stack pointer for the EBC. Get the current system stack
+ // pointer and adjust it down by the max needed for the interpreter.
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Align the stack on a natural boundary
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Allocate stack pool
+ //
+ Status = GetEBCStack((EFI_HANDLE)-1, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64)(UINTN) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN)VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] &= ~(sizeof (UINTN) - 1);
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+ //
+ // Put a magic value in the stack gap, then adjust down again
+ //
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE;
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // For IA32, this is where we say our return address is
+ //
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg16;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg15;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg14;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg13;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg12;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg11;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg10;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg9;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg8;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg7;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg6;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg5;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg4;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg3;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg2;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) Arg1;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= 16;
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // We need to keep track of where the EBC stack starts. This way, if the EBC
+ // accesses any stack variables above its initial stack setting, then we know
+ // it's accessing variables passed into it, which means the data is on the
+ // VM's stack.
+ // When we're called, on the stack (high to low) we have the parameters, the
+ // return address, then the saved ebp. Save the pointer to the return address.
+ // EBC code knows that's there, so should look above it for function parameters.
+ // The offset is the size of locals (VMContext + Addr + saved ebp).
+ // Note that the interpreter assumes there is a 16 bytes of return address on
+ // the stack too, so adjust accordingly.
+ // VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN)(Addr + sizeof (VmContext) + sizeof (Addr));
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStack(StackIndex);
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Begin executing an EBC image. The address of the entry point is passed
+ in via a processor register, so we'll need to make a call to get the
+ value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - image handle for the EBC application we're executing
+ SystemTable - standard system table passed into an driver's entry point
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value returned by the EBC application we're going to run.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register. Make sure you don't
+ // call any functions before this or you could mess up the register the
+ // entry point is passed in.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+
+ //
+ // Print(L"*** Thunked into EBC entry point - ImageHandle = 0x%X\n", (UINTN)ImageHandle);
+ // Print(L"EBC entry point is 0x%X\n", (UINT32)(UINTN)Addr);
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+
+ //
+ // Save the image handle so we can track the thunks created for this image
+ //
+ VmContext.ImageHandle = ImageHandle;
+ VmContext.SystemTable = SystemTable;
+
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+
+ //
+ // Initialize the stack pointer for the EBC. Get the current system stack
+ // pointer and adjust it down by the max needed for the interpreter.
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Allocate stack pool
+ //
+ Status = GetEBCStack(ImageHandle, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64)(UINTN) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN)VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+ //
+ // Put a magic value in the stack gap, then adjust down again
+ //
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE;
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // Align the stack on a natural boundary
+ // VmContext.R[0] &= ~(sizeof(UINTN) - 1);
+ //
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) SystemTable;
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) ImageHandle;
+
+ VmContext.R[0] -= 16;
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+ //
+ // VM pushes 16-bytes for return address. Simulate that here.
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcCreateThunks (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk,
+ IN UINT32 Flags
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Create an IA32 thunk for the given EBC entry point.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - Handle of image for which this thunk is being created
+ EbcEntryPoint - Address of the EBC code that the thunk is to call
+ Thunk - Returned thunk we create here
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI status.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINT8 *ThunkBase;
+ UINT32 I;
+ UINT32 Addr;
+ INT32 Size;
+ INT32 ThunkSize;
+
+ //
+ // Check alignment of pointer to EBC code
+ //
+ if ((UINT32) (UINTN) EbcEntryPoint & 0x01) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ Size = EBC_THUNK_SIZE;
+ ThunkSize = Size;
+
+ Ptr = AllocatePool (Size);
+
+ if (Ptr == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Print(L"Allocate TH: 0x%X\n", (UINT32)Ptr);
+ //
+ // Save the start address so we can add a pointer to it to a list later.
+ //
+ ThunkBase = Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Give them the address of our buffer we're going to fix up
+ //
+ *Thunk = (VOID *) Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Add a magic code here to help the VM recognize the thunk..
+ // mov eax, 0xca112ebc => B8 BC 2E 11 CA
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0xB8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ Addr = (UINT32) 0xCA112EBC;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) (UINTN) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Add code bytes to load up a processor register with the EBC entry point.
+ // mov eax, 0xaa55aa55 => B8 55 AA 55 AA
+ // The first 8 bytes of the thunk entry is the address of the EBC
+ // entry point.
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0xB8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ Addr = (UINT32) EbcEntryPoint;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) (UINTN) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+ //
+ // Stick in a load of ecx with the address of appropriate VM function.
+ // mov ecx 12345678h => 0xB9 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12
+ //
+ if (Flags & FLAG_THUNK_ENTRY_POINT) {
+ Addr = (UINT32) (UINTN) ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint;
+ } else {
+ Addr = (UINT32) (UINTN) EbcInterpret;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // MOV ecx
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0xB9;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+ //
+ // Stick in jump opcode bytes for jmp ecx => 0xFF 0xE1
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0xFF;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xE1;
+ Size--;
+
+ //
+ // Double check that our defined size is ok (application error)
+ //
+ if (Size < 0) {
+ ASSERT (FALSE);
+ return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
+ }
+ //
+ // Add the thunk to the list for this image. Do this last since the add
+ // function flushes the cache for us.
+ //
+ EbcAddImageThunk (ImageHandle, (VOID *) ThunkBase, ThunkSize);
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcLowLevel.s b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcLowLevel.s new file mode 100644 index 0000000..e329b68 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcLowLevel.s @@ -0,0 +1,197 @@ +//++
+// Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+// All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+// are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+// which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+// http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+//
+// THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+// WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+//
+// Module Name:
+//
+// EbcLowLevel.s
+//
+// Abstract:
+//
+// Contains low level routines for the Virtual Machine implementation
+// on an Itanium-based platform.
+//
+//
+//--
+
+.file "EbcLowLevel.s"
+
+#define PROCEDURE_ENTRY(name) .##text; \
+ .##type name, @function; \
+ .##proc name; \
+name::
+
+#define PROCEDURE_EXIT(name) .##endp name
+
+// Note: use of NESTED_SETUP requires number of locals (l) >= 3
+
+#define NESTED_SETUP(i,l,o,r) \
+ alloc loc1=ar##.##pfs,i,l,o,r ;\
+ mov loc0=b0
+
+#define NESTED_RETURN \
+ mov b0=loc0 ;\
+ mov ar##.##pfs=loc1 ;;\
+ br##.##ret##.##dpnt b0;;
+
+.type CopyMem, @function;
+
+//-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+//++
+// EbcAsmLLCALLEX
+//
+// Implements the low level EBC CALLEX instruction. Sets up the
+// stack pointer, does the spill of function arguments, and
+// calls the native function. On return it restores the original
+// stack pointer and returns to the caller.
+//
+// Arguments :
+//
+// On Entry :
+// in0 = Address of native code to call
+// in1 = New stack pointer
+//
+// Return Value:
+//
+// As per static calling conventions.
+//
+//--
+//---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+;// void EbcAsmLLCALLEX (UINTN FunctionAddr, UINTN EbcStackPointer)
+PROCEDURE_ENTRY(EbcAsmLLCALLEX)
+ NESTED_SETUP (2,6,8,0)
+
+ // NESTED_SETUP uses loc0 and loc1 for context save
+
+ //
+ // Save a copy of the EBC VM stack pointer
+ //
+ mov r8 = in1;;
+
+ //
+ // Copy stack arguments from EBC stack into registers.
+ // Assume worst case and copy 8.
+ //
+ ld8 out0 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out1 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out2 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out3 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out4 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out5 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out6 = [r8], 8;;
+ ld8 out7 = [r8], 8;;
+
+ //
+ // Save the original stack pointer
+ //
+ mov loc2 = r12;
+
+ //
+ // Save the gp
+ //
+ or loc3 = r1, r0
+
+ //
+ // Set the new aligned stack pointer. Reserve space for the required
+ // 16-bytes of scratch area as well.
+ //
+ add r12 = 48, in1
+
+ //
+ // Now call the function. Load up the function address from the descriptor
+ // pointed to by in0. Then get the gp from the descriptor at the following
+ // address in the descriptor.
+ //
+ ld8 r31 = [in0], 8;;
+ ld8 r30 = [in0];;
+ mov b1 = r31
+ mov r1 = r30
+ (p0) br.call.dptk.many b0 = b1;;
+
+ //
+ // Restore the original stack pointer and gp
+ //
+ mov r12 = loc2
+ or r1 = loc3, r0
+
+ //
+ // Now return
+ //
+ NESTED_RETURN
+
+PROCEDURE_EXIT(EbcAsmLLCALLEX)
+
+PROCEDURE_ENTRY(EbcLLCALLEXNative)
+ NESTED_SETUP (3,6,3,0)
+
+ mov loc2 = in2;;
+ mov loc3 = in1;;
+ sub loc2 = loc2, loc3
+ mov loc4 = r12;;
+ or loc5 = r1, r0
+
+ sub r12 = r12, loc2
+ mov out2 = loc2;;
+
+ and r12 = -0x10, r12
+ mov out1 = in1;;
+ mov out0 = r12;;
+ adds r12 = -0x8, r12
+ (p0) br.call.dptk.many b0 = CopyMem;;
+ adds r12 = 0x8, r12
+
+ mov out0 = in0;;
+ mov out1 = r12;;
+ (p0) br.call.dptk.many b0 = EbcAsmLLCALLEX;;
+ mov r12 = loc4;;
+ or r1 = loc5, r0
+
+ NESTED_RETURN
+PROCEDURE_EXIT(EbcLLCALLEXNative)
+
+
+//
+// UINTN EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint(VOID)
+//
+// Description:
+// Simply return, so that the caller retrieves the return register
+// contents (R8). That's where the thunk-to-ebc code stuffed the
+// EBC entry point.
+//
+PROCEDURE_ENTRY(EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint)
+ br.ret.sptk b0 ;;
+PROCEDURE_EXIT(EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint)
+
+//
+// INT64 EbcLLGetReturnValue(VOID)
+//
+// Description:
+// This function is called to get the value returned by native code
+// to EBC. It simply returns because the return value should still
+// be in the register, so the caller just gets the unmodified value.
+//
+PROCEDURE_ENTRY(EbcLLGetReturnValue)
+ br.ret.sptk b0 ;;
+PROCEDURE_EXIT(EbcLLGetReturnValue)
+
+//
+// UINTN EbcLLGetStackPointer(VOID)
+//
+PROCEDURE_ENTRY(EbcLLGetStackPointer)
+ mov r8 = r12 ;;
+ br.ret.sptk b0 ;;
+ br.sptk.few b6
+PROCEDURE_EXIT(EbcLLGetStackPointer)
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..3647a12 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.c @@ -0,0 +1,869 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcSupport.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ This module contains EBC support routines that are customized based on
+ the target processor.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "EbcInt.h"
+#include "EbcExecute.h"
+#include "EbcSupport.h"
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+WriteBundle (
+ IN VOID *MemPtr,
+ IN UINT8 Template,
+ IN UINT64 Slot0,
+ IN UINT64 Slot1,
+ IN UINT64 Slot2
+ );
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+PushU64 (
+ VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINT64 Arg
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Advance the VM stack down, and then copy the argument to the stack.
+ // Hope it's aligned.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= sizeof (UINT64);
+ *(UINT64 *) VmPtr->R[0] = Arg;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+EbcInterpret (
+ UINT64 Arg1,
+ ...
+ )
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+ VA_LIST List;
+ UINT64 Arg2;
+ UINT64 Arg3;
+ UINT64 Arg4;
+ UINT64 Arg5;
+ UINT64 Arg6;
+ UINT64 Arg7;
+ UINT64 Arg8;
+ UINT64 Arg9;
+ UINT64 Arg10;
+ UINT64 Arg11;
+ UINT64 Arg12;
+ UINT64 Arg13;
+ UINT64 Arg14;
+ UINT64 Arg15;
+ UINT64 Arg16;
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register. Make sure you don't
+ // call any functions before this or you could mess up the register the
+ // entry point is passed in.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+ //
+ // Need the args off the stack.
+ //
+ VA_START (List, Arg1);
+ Arg2 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg3 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg4 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg5 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg6 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg7 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg8 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg9 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg10 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg11 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg12 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg13 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg14 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg15 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ Arg16 = VA_ARG (List, UINT64);
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+ //
+ // Initialize the stack pointer for the EBC. Get the current system stack
+ // pointer and adjust it down by the max needed for the interpreter.
+ //
+ //
+ // NOTE: Eventually we should have the interpreter allocate memory
+ // for stack space which it will use during its execution. This
+ // would likely improve performance because the interpreter would
+ // no longer be required to test each memory access and adjust
+ // those reading from the stack gap.
+ //
+ // For IPF, the stack looks like (assuming 10 args passed)
+ // arg10
+ // arg9 (Bottom of high stack)
+ // [ stack gap for interpreter execution ]
+ // [ magic value for detection of stack corruption ]
+ // arg8 (Top of low stack)
+ // arg7....
+ // arg1
+ // [ 64-bit return address ]
+ // [ ebc stack ]
+ // If the EBC accesses memory in the stack gap, then we assume that it's
+ // actually trying to access args9 and greater. Therefore we need to
+ // adjust memory accesses in this region to point above the stack gap.
+ //
+ //
+ // Now adjust the EBC stack pointer down to leave a gap for interpreter
+ // execution. Then stuff a magic value there.
+ //
+
+ Status = GetEBCStack((EFI_HANDLE)(UINTN)-1, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE);
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ //
+ // Push the EBC arguments on the stack. Does not matter that they may not
+ // all be valid.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg16);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg15);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg14);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg13);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg12);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg11);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg10);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg9);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg8);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg7);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg6);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg5);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg4);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg3);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg2);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, Arg1);
+ //
+ // Push a bogus return address on the EBC stack because the
+ // interpreter expects one there. For stack alignment purposes on IPF,
+ // EBC return addresses are always 16 bytes. Push a bogus value as well.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, 0);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, 0xDEADBEEFDEADBEEF);
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStack(StackIndex);
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ IPF implementation.
+
+ Begin executing an EBC image. The address of the entry point is passed
+ in via a processor register, so we'll need to make a call to get the
+ value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - image handle for the EBC application we're executing
+ SystemTable - standard system table passed into an driver's entry point
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value returned by the EBC application we're going to run.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register. Make sure you don't
+ // call any functions before this or you could mess up the register the
+ // entry point is passed in.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+
+ //
+ // Save the image handle so we can track the thunks created for this image
+ //
+ VmContext.ImageHandle = ImageHandle;
+ VmContext.SystemTable = SystemTable;
+
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+
+ //
+ // Get the stack pointer. This is the bottom of the upper stack.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetStackPointer ();
+
+ Status = GetEBCStack(ImageHandle, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+
+ //
+ // Allocate stack space for the interpreter. Then put a magic value
+ // at the bottom so we can detect stack corruption.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE);
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // When we thunk to external native code, we copy the last 8 qwords from
+ // the EBC stack into the processor registers, and adjust the stack pointer
+ // up. If the caller is not passing 8 parameters, then we've moved the
+ // stack pointer up into the stack gap. If this happens, then the caller
+ // can mess up the stack gap contents (in particular our magic value).
+ // Therefore, leave another gap below the magic value. Pick 10 qwords down,
+ // just as a starting point.
+ //
+ VmContext.R[0] -= 10 * sizeof (UINT64);
+
+ //
+ // Align the stack pointer such that after pushing the system table,
+ // image handle, and return address on the stack, it's aligned on a 16-byte
+ // boundary as required for IPF.
+ //
+ VmContext.R[0] &= (INT64)~0x0f;
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ //
+ // Simply copy the image handle and system table onto the EBC stack.
+ // Greatly simplifies things by not having to spill the args
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) SystemTable);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) ImageHandle);
+
+ //
+ // Interpreter assumes 64-bit return address is pushed on the stack.
+ // IPF does not do this so pad the stack accordingly. Also, a
+ // "return address" is 16 bytes as required for IPF stack alignments.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0x1234567887654321);
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStack(StackIndex);
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcCreateThunks (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk,
+ IN UINT32 Flags
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Create thunks for an EBC image entry point, or an EBC protocol service.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - Image handle for the EBC image. If not null, then we're
+ creating a thunk for an image entry point.
+ EbcEntryPoint - Address of the EBC code that the thunk is to call
+ Thunk - Returned thunk we create here
+ Flags - Flags indicating options for creating the thunk
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI status.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINT8 *ThunkBase;
+ UINT64 Addr;
+ UINT64 Code[3]; // Code in a bundle
+ UINT64 RegNum; // register number for MOVL
+ UINT64 I; // bits of MOVL immediate data
+ UINT64 Ic; // bits of MOVL immediate data
+ UINT64 Imm5c; // bits of MOVL immediate data
+ UINT64 Imm9d; // bits of MOVL immediate data
+ UINT64 Imm7b; // bits of MOVL immediate data
+ UINT64 Br; // branch register for loading and jumping
+ UINT64 *Data64Ptr;
+ UINT32 ThunkSize;
+ UINT32 Size;
+
+ //
+ // Check alignment of pointer to EBC code, which must always be aligned
+ // on a 2-byte boundary.
+ //
+ if ((UINT32) (UINTN) EbcEntryPoint & 0x01) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ //
+ // Allocate memory for the thunk. Make the (most likely incorrect) assumption
+ // that the returned buffer is not aligned, so round up to the next
+ // alignment size.
+ //
+ Size = EBC_THUNK_SIZE + EBC_THUNK_ALIGNMENT - 1;
+ ThunkSize = Size;
+ Ptr = AllocatePool (Size);
+
+ if (Ptr == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Save the start address of the buffer.
+ //
+ ThunkBase = Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Make sure it's aligned for code execution. If not, then
+ // round up.
+ //
+ if ((UINT32) (UINTN) Ptr & (EBC_THUNK_ALIGNMENT - 1)) {
+ Ptr = (UINT8 *) (((UINTN) Ptr + (EBC_THUNK_ALIGNMENT - 1)) &~ (UINT64) (EBC_THUNK_ALIGNMENT - 1));
+ }
+ //
+ // Return the pointer to the thunk to the caller to user as the
+ // image entry point.
+ //
+ *Thunk = (VOID *) Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Clear out the thunk entry
+ // ZeroMem(Ptr, Size);
+ //
+ // For IPF, when you do a call via a function pointer, the function pointer
+ // actually points to a function descriptor which consists of a 64-bit
+ // address of the function, followed by a 64-bit gp for the function being
+ // called. See the the Software Conventions and Runtime Architecture Guide
+ // for details.
+ // So first off in our thunk, create a descriptor for our actual thunk code.
+ // This means we need to create a pointer to the thunk code (which follows
+ // the descriptor we're going to create), followed by the gp of the Vm
+ // interpret function we're going to eventually execute.
+ //
+ Data64Ptr = (UINT64 *) Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Write the function's entry point (which is our thunk code that follows
+ // this descriptor we're creating).
+ //
+ *Data64Ptr = (UINT64) (Data64Ptr + 2);
+ //
+ // Get the gp from the descriptor for EbcInterpret and stuff it in our thunk
+ // descriptor.
+ //
+ *(Data64Ptr + 1) = *(UINT64 *) ((UINT64 *) (UINTN) EbcInterpret + 1);
+ //
+ // Advance our thunk data pointer past the descriptor. Since the
+ // descriptor consists of 16 bytes, the pointer is still aligned for
+ // IPF code execution (on 16-byte boundary).
+ //
+ Ptr += sizeof (UINT64) * 2;
+
+ //
+ // *************************** MAGIC BUNDLE ********************************
+ //
+ // Write magic code bundle for: movl r8 = 0xca112ebcca112ebc to help the VM
+ // to recognize it is a thunk.
+ //
+ Addr = (UINT64) 0xCA112EBCCA112EBC;
+
+ //
+ // Now generate the code bytes. First is nop.m 0x0
+ //
+ Code[0] = OPCODE_NOP;
+
+ //
+ // Next is simply Addr[62:22] (41 bits) of the address
+ //
+ Code[1] = RShiftU64 (Addr, 22) & 0x1ffffffffff;
+
+ //
+ // Extract bits from the address for insertion into the instruction
+ // i = Addr[63:63]
+ //
+ I = RShiftU64 (Addr, 63) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // ic = Addr[21:21]
+ //
+ Ic = RShiftU64 (Addr, 21) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // imm5c = Addr[20:16] for 5 bits
+ //
+ Imm5c = RShiftU64 (Addr, 16) & 0x1F;
+ //
+ // imm9d = Addr[15:7] for 9 bits
+ //
+ Imm9d = RShiftU64 (Addr, 7) & 0x1FF;
+ //
+ // imm7b = Addr[6:0] for 7 bits
+ //
+ Imm7b = Addr & 0x7F;
+
+ //
+ // The EBC entry point will be put into r8, so r8 can be used here
+ // temporary. R8 is general register and is auto-serialized.
+ //
+ RegNum = 8;
+
+ //
+ // Next is jumbled data, including opcode and rest of address
+ //
+ Code[2] = LShiftU64 (Imm7b, 13);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (0x00, 20); // vc
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Ic, 21);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm5c, 22);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm9d, 27);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (I, 36);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((UINT64)MOVL_OPCODE, 37);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((RegNum & 0x7F), 6);
+
+ WriteBundle ((VOID *) Ptr, 0x05, Code[0], Code[1], Code[2]);
+
+ //
+ // *************************** FIRST BUNDLE ********************************
+ //
+ // Write code bundle for: movl r8 = EBC_ENTRY_POINT so we pass
+ // the ebc entry point in to the interpreter function via a processor
+ // register.
+ // Note -- we could easily change this to pass in a pointer to a structure
+ // that contained, among other things, the EBC image's entry point. But
+ // for now pass it directly.
+ //
+ Ptr += 16;
+ Addr = (UINT64) EbcEntryPoint;
+
+ //
+ // Now generate the code bytes. First is nop.m 0x0
+ //
+ Code[0] = OPCODE_NOP;
+
+ //
+ // Next is simply Addr[62:22] (41 bits) of the address
+ //
+ Code[1] = RShiftU64 (Addr, 22) & 0x1ffffffffff;
+
+ //
+ // Extract bits from the address for insertion into the instruction
+ // i = Addr[63:63]
+ //
+ I = RShiftU64 (Addr, 63) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // ic = Addr[21:21]
+ //
+ Ic = RShiftU64 (Addr, 21) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // imm5c = Addr[20:16] for 5 bits
+ //
+ Imm5c = RShiftU64 (Addr, 16) & 0x1F;
+ //
+ // imm9d = Addr[15:7] for 9 bits
+ //
+ Imm9d = RShiftU64 (Addr, 7) & 0x1FF;
+ //
+ // imm7b = Addr[6:0] for 7 bits
+ //
+ Imm7b = Addr & 0x7F;
+
+ //
+ // Put the EBC entry point in r8, which is the location of the return value
+ // for functions.
+ //
+ RegNum = 8;
+
+ //
+ // Next is jumbled data, including opcode and rest of address
+ //
+ Code[2] = LShiftU64 (Imm7b, 13);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (0x00, 20); // vc
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Ic, 21);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm5c, 22);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm9d, 27);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (I, 36);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((UINT64)MOVL_OPCODE, 37);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((RegNum & 0x7F), 6);
+
+ WriteBundle ((VOID *) Ptr, 0x05, Code[0], Code[1], Code[2]);
+
+ //
+ // *************************** NEXT BUNDLE *********************************
+ //
+ // Write code bundle for:
+ // movl rx = offset_of(EbcInterpret|ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint)
+ //
+ // Advance pointer to next bundle, then compute the offset from this bundle
+ // to the address of the entry point of the interpreter.
+ //
+ Ptr += 16;
+ if (Flags & FLAG_THUNK_ENTRY_POINT) {
+ Addr = (UINT64) ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint;
+ } else {
+ Addr = (UINT64) EbcInterpret;
+ }
+ //
+ // Indirection on Itanium-based systems
+ //
+ Addr = *(UINT64 *) Addr;
+
+ //
+ // Now write the code to load the offset into a register
+ //
+ Code[0] = OPCODE_NOP;
+
+ //
+ // Next is simply Addr[62:22] (41 bits) of the address
+ //
+ Code[1] = RShiftU64 (Addr, 22) & 0x1ffffffffff;
+
+ //
+ // Extract bits from the address for insertion into the instruction
+ // i = Addr[63:63]
+ //
+ I = RShiftU64 (Addr, 63) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // ic = Addr[21:21]
+ //
+ Ic = RShiftU64 (Addr, 21) & 0x01;
+ //
+ // imm5c = Addr[20:16] for 5 bits
+ //
+ Imm5c = RShiftU64 (Addr, 16) & 0x1F;
+ //
+ // imm9d = Addr[15:7] for 9 bits
+ //
+ Imm9d = RShiftU64 (Addr, 7) & 0x1FF;
+ //
+ // imm7b = Addr[6:0] for 7 bits
+ //
+ Imm7b = Addr & 0x7F;
+
+ //
+ // Put it in r31, a scratch register
+ //
+ RegNum = 31;
+
+ //
+ // Next is jumbled data, including opcode and rest of address
+ //
+ Code[2] = LShiftU64(Imm7b, 13);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (0x00, 20); // vc
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Ic, 21);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm5c, 22);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (Imm9d, 27);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 (I, 36);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((UINT64)MOVL_OPCODE, 37);
+ Code[2] = Code[2] | LShiftU64 ((RegNum & 0x7F), 6);
+
+ WriteBundle ((VOID *) Ptr, 0x05, Code[0], Code[1], Code[2]);
+
+ //
+ // *************************** NEXT BUNDLE *********************************
+ //
+ // Load branch register with EbcInterpret() function offset from the bundle
+ // address: mov b6 = RegNum
+ //
+ // See volume 3 page 4-29 of the Arch. Software Developer's Manual.
+ //
+ // Advance pointer to next bundle
+ //
+ Ptr += 16;
+ Code[0] = OPCODE_NOP;
+ Code[1] = OPCODE_NOP;
+ Code[2] = OPCODE_MOV_BX_RX;
+
+ //
+ // Pick a branch register to use. Then fill in the bits for the branch
+ // register and user register (same user register as previous bundle).
+ //
+ Br = 6;
+ Code[2] |= LShiftU64 (Br, 6);
+ Code[2] |= LShiftU64 (RegNum, 13);
+ WriteBundle ((VOID *) Ptr, 0x0d, Code[0], Code[1], Code[2]);
+
+ //
+ // *************************** NEXT BUNDLE *********************************
+ //
+ // Now do the branch: (p0) br.cond.sptk.few b6
+ //
+ // Advance pointer to next bundle.
+ // Fill in the bits for the branch register (same reg as previous bundle)
+ //
+ Ptr += 16;
+ Code[0] = OPCODE_NOP;
+ Code[1] = OPCODE_NOP;
+ Code[2] = OPCODE_BR_COND_SPTK_FEW;
+ Code[2] |= LShiftU64 (Br, 13);
+ WriteBundle ((VOID *) Ptr, 0x1d, Code[0], Code[1], Code[2]);
+
+ //
+ // Add the thunk to our list of allocated thunks so we can do some cleanup
+ // when the image is unloaded. Do this last since the Add function flushes
+ // the instruction cache for us.
+ //
+ EbcAddImageThunk (ImageHandle, (VOID *) ThunkBase, ThunkSize);
+
+ //
+ // Done
+ //
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+WriteBundle (
+ IN VOID *MemPtr,
+ IN UINT8 Template,
+ IN UINT64 Slot0,
+ IN UINT64 Slot1,
+ IN UINT64 Slot2
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Given raw bytes of Itanium based code, format them into a bundle and
+ write them out.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ MemPtr - pointer to memory location to write the bundles to
+ Template - 5-bit template
+ Slot0-2 - instruction slot data for the bundle
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Pointer is not aligned
+ - No more than 5 bits in template
+ - More than 41 bits used in code
+ EFI_SUCCESS - All data is written.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 *BPtr;
+ UINT32 Index;
+ UINT64 Low64;
+ UINT64 High64;
+
+ //
+ // Verify pointer is aligned
+ //
+ if ((UINT64) MemPtr & 0xF) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ //
+ // Verify no more than 5 bits in template
+ //
+ if (Template &~0x1F) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ //
+ // Verify max of 41 bits used in code
+ //
+ if ((Slot0 | Slot1 | Slot2) &~0x1ffffffffff) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ Low64 = LShiftU64 (Slot1, 46);
+ Low64 = Low64 | LShiftU64 (Slot0, 5) | Template;
+
+ High64 = RShiftU64 (Slot1, 18);
+ High64 = High64 | LShiftU64 (Slot2, 23);
+
+ //
+ // Now write it all out
+ //
+ BPtr = (UINT8 *) MemPtr;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < 8; Index++) {
+ *BPtr = (UINT8) Low64;
+ Low64 = RShiftU64 (Low64, 8);
+ BPtr++;
+ }
+
+ for (Index = 0; Index < 8; Index++) {
+ *BPtr = (UINT8) High64;
+ High64 = RShiftU64 (High64, 8);
+ BPtr++;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+VOID
+EbcLLCALLEX (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN FuncAddr,
+ IN UINTN NewStackPointer,
+ IN VOID *FramePtr,
+ IN UINT8 Size
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction.
+ The function check the callee's content to see whether it is common native
+ code or a thunk to another piece of EBC code.
+ If the callee is common native code, use EbcLLCAllEXASM to manipulate,
+ otherwise, set the VM->IP to target EBC code directly to avoid another VM
+ be startup which cost time and stack space.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - Pointer to a VM context.
+ FuncAddr - Callee's address
+ NewStackPointer - New stack pointer after the call
+ FramePtr - New frame pointer after the call
+ Size - The size of call instruction
+
+Returns:
+
+ None.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN IsThunk;
+ UINTN TargetEbcAddr;
+ UINTN CodeOne18;
+ UINTN CodeOne23;
+ UINTN CodeTwoI;
+ UINTN CodeTwoIc;
+ UINTN CodeTwo7b;
+ UINTN CodeTwo5c;
+ UINTN CodeTwo9d;
+ UINTN CalleeAddr;
+
+ IsThunk = 1;
+ TargetEbcAddr = 0;
+
+ //
+ // FuncAddr points to the descriptor of the target instructions.
+ //
+ CalleeAddr = *((UINT64 *)FuncAddr);
+
+ //
+ // Processor specific code to check whether the callee is a thunk to EBC.
+ //
+ if (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr) != 0xBCCA000100000005) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 1) != 0x697623C1004A112E) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+
+ CodeOne18 = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 2), 46) & 0x3FFFF;
+ CodeOne23 = (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3)) & 0x7FFFFF;
+ CodeTwoI = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3), 59) & 0x1;
+ CodeTwoIc = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3), 44) & 0x1;
+ CodeTwo7b = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3), 36) & 0x7F;
+ CodeTwo5c = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3), 45) & 0x1F;
+ CodeTwo9d = RShiftU64 (*((UINT64 *)CalleeAddr + 3), 50) & 0x1FF;
+
+ TargetEbcAddr = CodeTwo7b;
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeTwo9d, 7);
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeTwo5c, 16);
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeTwoIc, 21);
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeOne18, 22);
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeOne23, 40);
+ TargetEbcAddr = TargetEbcAddr | LShiftU64 (CodeTwoI, 63);
+
+Action:
+ if (IsThunk == 1){
+ //
+ // The callee is a thunk to EBC, adjust the stack pointer down 16 bytes and
+ // put our return address and frame pointer on the VM stack.
+ // Then set the VM's IP to new EBC code.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINTN) FramePtr);
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0];
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINT64) (VmPtr->Ip + Size));
+
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) TargetEbcAddr;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // The callee is not a thunk to EBC, call native code.
+ //
+ EbcLLCALLEXNative (FuncAddr, NewStackPointer, FramePtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get return value and advance the IP.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[7] = EbcLLGetReturnValue ();
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..f6c929b --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/Ipf/EbcSupport.h @@ -0,0 +1,56 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcSupport.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Definition of EBC Support function
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _IPF_EBC_SUPPORT_H_
+#define _IPF_EBC_SUPPORT_H_
+
+#define VM_STACK_SIZE (1024 * 32)
+
+#define EBC_THUNK_SIZE 128
+#define STACK_REMAIN_SIZE (1024 * 4)
+
+//
+// For code execution, thunks must be aligned on 16-byte boundary
+//
+#define EBC_THUNK_ALIGNMENT 16
+
+//
+// Opcodes for IPF instructions. We'll need to hand-create thunk code (stuffing
+// bits) to insert a jump to the interpreter.
+//
+#define OPCODE_NOP (UINT64) 0x00008000000
+#define OPCODE_BR_COND_SPTK_FEW (UINT64) 0x00100000000
+#define OPCODE_MOV_BX_RX (UINT64) 0x00E00100000
+
+//
+// Opcode for MOVL instruction
+//
+#define MOVL_OPCODE 0x06
+
+VOID
+EbcAsmLLCALLEX (
+ IN UINTN CallAddr,
+ IN UINTN EbcSp
+ );
+
+#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.S b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.S new file mode 100644 index 0000000..5384625 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.S @@ -0,0 +1,144 @@ +#****************************************************************************
+#*
+#* Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+#* All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+#* are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+#* which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+#* http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+#*
+#* THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+#* WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#*
+#****************************************************************************
+#****************************************************************************
+# REV 1.0
+#****************************************************************************
+#
+# Rev Date Description
+# --- -------- ------------------------------------------------------------
+# 1.0 05/09/12 Initial creation of file.
+#
+#****************************************************************************
+
+#* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+# This code provides low level routines that support the Virtual Machine
+# for option ROMs.
+#* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+# Equate files needed.
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+##GenericPostSegment SEGMENT USE16
+#---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+#****************************************************************************
+# EbcLLCALLEX
+#
+# This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction.
+# This instruction requires that we thunk out to external native
+# code. For x64, we switch stacks, copy the arguments to the stack
+# and jump to the specified function.
+# On return, we restore the stack pointer to its original location.
+#
+# Destroys no working registers.
+#****************************************************************************
+.global _CopyMem;
+
+# VOID EbcLLCALLEXNative(UINTN FuncAddr, UINTN NewStackPointer, VOID *FramePtr)
+.global _EbcLLCALLEXNative;
+_EbcLLCALLEXNative:
+ push %rbp
+ push %rbx
+ mov %rsp, %rbp
+ # Function prolog
+
+ # Copy FuncAddr to a preserved register.
+ mov %rcx, %rbx
+
+ # Set stack pointer to new value
+ sub %r8, %rdx
+ sub %rsp, %r8
+ mov %rsp, %rcx
+ sub %rsp, 0x20
+ call _CopyMem
+ add %rsp, 0x20
+
+ # Considering the worst case, load 4 potiential arguments
+ # into registers.
+ mov (%rsp), %rcx
+ mov 8(%rsp), %rdx
+ mov 10(%rsp), %r8
+ mov 18(%rsp), %r9
+
+ # Now call the external routine
+ call *%rbx
+
+ # Function epilog
+ mov %rbp, %rsp
+ pop %rbx
+ pop %rbp
+ ret
+
+
+# UINTN EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint(VOID);
+# Routine Description:
+# The VM thunk code stuffs an EBC entry point into a processor
+# register. Since we can't use inline assembly to get it from
+# the interpreter C code, stuff it into the return value
+# register and return.
+#
+# Arguments:
+# None.
+#
+# Returns:
+# The contents of the register in which the entry point is passed.
+#
+.global _EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint;
+_EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint:
+ ret
+
+#/*++
+#
+#Routine Description:
+#
+# Return the caller's value of the stack pointer.
+#
+#Arguments:
+#
+# None.
+#
+#Returns:
+#
+# The current value of the stack pointer for the caller. We
+# adjust it by 4 here because when they called us, the return address
+# is put on the stack, thereby lowering it by 4 bytes.
+#
+#--*/
+
+# UINTN EbcLLGetStackPointer()
+.global _EbcLLGetStackPointer;
+_EbcLLGetStackPointer:
+ mov %rsp, %rax
+ # Stack adjusted by this much when we were called,
+ # For this function, it's 4.
+ add $4, %rax
+ ret
+
+.global _EbcLLGetReturnValue;
+_EbcLLGetReturnValue:
+# UINT64 EbcLLGetReturnValue(VOID);
+# Routine Description:
+# When EBC calls native, on return the VM has to stuff the return
+# value into a VM register. It's assumed here that the value is still
+# in the register, so simply return and the caller should get the
+# return result properly.
+#
+# Arguments:
+# None.
+#
+# Returns:
+# The unmodified value returned by the native code.
+#
+ ret
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.asm b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.asm new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7b59e93 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcLowLevel.asm @@ -0,0 +1,154 @@ + page ,132
+ title VM ASSEMBLY LANGUAGE ROUTINES
+;****************************************************************************
+;*
+;* Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+;* All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+;* are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+;* which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+;* http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+;*
+;* THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+;* WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+;*
+;****************************************************************************
+;****************************************************************************
+; REV 1.0
+;****************************************************************************
+;
+; Rev Date Description
+; --- -------- ------------------------------------------------------------
+; 1.0 05/09/12 Initial creation of file.
+;
+;****************************************************************************
+
+;* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+; This code provides low level routines that support the Virtual Machine
+; for option ROMs.
+;* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
+
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+; Equate files needed.
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+text SEGMENT
+
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+;;GenericPostSegment SEGMENT USE16
+;---------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+;****************************************************************************
+; EbcLLCALLEX
+;
+; This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction.
+; This instruction requires that we thunk out to external native
+; code. For x64, we switch stacks, copy the arguments to the stack
+; and jump to the specified function.
+; On return, we restore the stack pointer to its original location.
+;
+; Destroys no working registers.
+;****************************************************************************
+; VOID EbcLLCALLEXNative(UINTN FuncAddr, UINTN NewStackPointer, VOID *FramePtr)
+
+CopyMem PROTO Destination:PTR DWORD, Source:PTR DWORD, Count:DWORD
+
+
+EbcLLCALLEXNative PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ push rbp
+ push rbx
+ mov rbp, rsp
+ ; Function prolog
+
+ ; Copy FuncAddr to a preserved register.
+ mov rbx, rcx
+
+ ; Set stack pointer to new value
+ sub r8, rdx
+ sub rsp, r8
+ mov rcx, rsp
+ sub rsp, 20h
+ call CopyMem
+ add rsp, 20h
+
+ ; Considering the worst case, load 4 potiential arguments
+ ; into registers.
+ mov rcx, qword ptr [rsp]
+ mov rdx, qword ptr [rsp+8h]
+ mov r8, qword ptr [rsp+10h]
+ mov r9, qword ptr [rsp+18h]
+
+ ; Now call the external routine
+ call rbx
+
+ ; Function epilog
+ mov rsp, rbp
+ pop rbx
+ pop rbp
+ ret
+EbcLLCALLEXNative ENDP
+
+
+; UINTN EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint(VOID);
+; Routine Description:
+; The VM thunk code stuffs an EBC entry point into a processor
+; register. Since we can't use inline assembly to get it from
+; the interpreter C code, stuff it into the return value
+; register and return.
+;
+; Arguments:
+; None.
+;
+; Returns:
+; The contents of the register in which the entry point is passed.
+;
+EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ ret
+EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ENDP
+
+;/*++
+;
+;Routine Description:
+;
+; Return the caller's value of the stack pointer.
+;
+;Arguments:
+;
+; None.
+;
+;Returns:
+;
+; The current value of the stack pointer for the caller. We
+; adjust it by 4 here because when they called us, the return address
+; is put on the stack, thereby lowering it by 4 bytes.
+;
+;--*/
+
+; UINTN EbcLLGetStackPointer()
+EbcLLGetStackPointer PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ mov rax, rsp ; get current stack pointer
+ ; Stack adjusted by this much when we were called,
+ ; For this function, it's 4.
+ add rax, 4
+ ret
+EbcLLGetStackPointer ENDP
+
+; UINT64 EbcLLGetReturnValue(VOID);
+; Routine Description:
+; When EBC calls native, on return the VM has to stuff the return
+; value into a VM register. It's assumed here that the value is still
+; in the register, so simply return and the caller should get the
+; return result properly.
+;
+; Arguments:
+; None.
+;
+; Returns:
+; The unmodified value returned by the native code.
+;
+EbcLLGetReturnValue PROC NEAR PUBLIC
+ ret
+EbcLLGetReturnValue ENDP
+
+text ENDS
+END
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcSupport.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcSupport.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..bec82d6 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/Ebc/Dxe/x64/EbcSupport.c @@ -0,0 +1,619 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ EbcSupport.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ This module contains EBC support routines that are customized based on
+ the target x64 processor.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "EbcInt.h"
+#include "EbcExecute.h"
+
+//
+// NOTE: This is the stack size allocated for the interpreter
+// when it executes an EBC image. The requirements can change
+// based on whether or not a debugger is present, and other
+// platform-specific configurations.
+//
+#define VM_STACK_SIZE (1024 * 8)
+#define EBC_THUNK_SIZE 64
+
+#define STACK_REMAIN_SIZE (1024 * 4)
+
+STATIC
+VOID
+PushU64 (
+ VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ UINT64 Arg
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Push a 64 bit unsigned value to the VM stack.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - The pointer to current VM context.
+ Arg - The value to be pushed
+
+Returns:
+
+ VOID
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Advance the VM stack down, and then copy the argument to the stack.
+ // Hope it's aligned.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= sizeof (UINT64);
+ *(UINT64 *) VmPtr->R[0] = Arg;
+ return;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+EbcInterpret (
+ UINTN Arg1,
+ UINTN Arg2,
+ UINTN Arg3,
+ UINTN Arg4,
+ UINTN Arg5,
+ UINTN Arg6,
+ UINTN Arg7,
+ UINTN Arg8,
+ UINTN Arg9,
+ UINTN Arg10,
+ UINTN Arg11,
+ UINTN Arg12,
+ UINTN Arg13,
+ UINTN Arg14,
+ UINTN Arg15,
+ UINTN Arg16
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Begin executing an EBC image. The address of the entry point is passed
+ in via a processor register, so we'll need to make a call to get the
+ value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This is a thunk function. Microsoft x64 compiler only provide fast_call
+ calling convention, so the first four arguments are passed by rcx, rdx,
+ r8, and r9, while other arguments are passed in stack.
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value returned by the EBC application we're going to run.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register.
+ // Don't call any function before getting the EBC entry
+ // point because this will collab the return register.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+
+ //
+ // Initialize the stack pointer for the EBC. Get the current system stack
+ // pointer and adjust it down by the max needed for the interpreter.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetStackPointer ();
+
+ //
+ // Adjust the VM's stack pointer down.
+ //
+
+ Status = GetEBCStack((EFI_HANDLE)(UINTN)-1, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+ //
+ // Align the stack on a natural boundary.
+ //
+ VmContext.R[0] &= ~(sizeof (UINTN) - 1);
+
+ //
+ // Put a magic value in the stack gap, then adjust down again.
+ //
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE;
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // The stack upper to LowStackTop is belong to the VM.
+ //
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // For the worst case, assume there are 4 arguments passed in registers, store
+ // them to VM's stack.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg16);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg15);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg14);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg13);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg12);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg11);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg10);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg9);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg8);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg7);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg6);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg5);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg4);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg3);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg2);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) Arg1);
+
+ //
+ // Interpreter assumes 64-bit return address is pushed on the stack.
+ // The x64 does not do this so pad the stack accordingly.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0x1234567887654321ULL);
+
+ //
+ // For x64, this is where we say our return address is
+ //
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // We need to keep track of where the EBC stack starts. This way, if the EBC
+ // accesses any stack variables above its initial stack setting, then we know
+ // it's accessing variables passed into it, which means the data is on the
+ // VM's stack.
+ // When we're called, on the stack (high to low) we have the parameters, the
+ // return address, then the saved ebp. Save the pointer to the return address.
+ // EBC code knows that's there, so should look above it for function parameters.
+ // The offset is the size of locals (VMContext + Addr + saved ebp).
+ // Note that the interpreter assumes there is a 16 bytes of return address on
+ // the stack too, so adjust accordingly.
+ // VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN)(Addr + sizeof (VmContext) + sizeof (Addr));
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStack(StackIndex);
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT64
+ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Begin executing an EBC image. The address of the entry point is passed
+ in via a processor register, so we'll need to make a call to get the
+ value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - image handle for the EBC application we're executing
+ SystemTable - standard system table passed into an driver's entry point
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value returned by the EBC application we're going to run.
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Create a new VM context on the stack
+ //
+ VM_CONTEXT VmContext;
+ UINTN Addr;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN StackIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Get the EBC entry point from the processor register. Make sure you don't
+ // call any functions before this or you could mess up the register the
+ // entry point is passed in.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetEbcEntryPoint ();
+
+ //
+ // Now clear out our context
+ //
+ ZeroMem ((VOID *) &VmContext, sizeof (VM_CONTEXT));
+
+ //
+ // Save the image handle so we can track the thunks created for this image
+ //
+ VmContext.ImageHandle = ImageHandle;
+ VmContext.SystemTable = SystemTable;
+
+ //
+ // Set the VM instruction pointer to the correct location in memory.
+ //
+ VmContext.Ip = (VMIP) Addr;
+
+ //
+ // Initialize the stack pointer for the EBC. Get the current system stack
+ // pointer and adjust it down by the max needed for the interpreter.
+ //
+ Addr = EbcLLGetStackPointer ();
+
+ Status = GetEBCStack(ImageHandle, &VmContext.StackPool, &StackIndex);
+ if (EFI_ERROR(Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ VmContext.StackTop = (UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + (STACK_REMAIN_SIZE);
+ VmContext.R[0] = (UINT64) ((UINT8*)VmContext.StackPool + STACK_POOL_SIZE);
+ VmContext.HighStackBottom = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+ VmContext.R[0] -= sizeof (UINTN);
+
+
+ //
+ // Put a magic value in the stack gap, then adjust down again
+ //
+ *(UINTN *) (UINTN) (VmContext.R[0]) = (UINTN) VM_STACK_KEY_VALUE;
+ VmContext.StackMagicPtr = (UINTN *) (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // Align the stack on a natural boundary
+ VmContext.R[0] &= ~(sizeof(UINTN) - 1);
+ //
+ VmContext.LowStackTop = (UINTN) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // Simply copy the image handle and system table onto the EBC stack.
+ // Greatly simplifies things by not having to spill the args.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) SystemTable);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) ImageHandle);
+
+ //
+ // VM pushes 16-bytes for return address. Simulate that here.
+ //
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0);
+ PushU64 (&VmContext, (UINT64) 0x1234567887654321ULL);
+
+ //
+ // For x64, this is where we say our return address is
+ //
+ VmContext.StackRetAddr = (UINT64) VmContext.R[0];
+
+ //
+ // Entry function needn't access high stack context, simply
+ // put the stack pointer here.
+ //
+
+ //
+ // Begin executing the EBC code
+ //
+ EbcExecute (&VmContext);
+
+ //
+ // Return the value in R[7] unless there was an error
+ //
+ ReturnEBCStack(StackIndex);
+ return (UINT64) VmContext.R[7];
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EbcCreateThunks (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN VOID *EbcEntryPoint,
+ OUT VOID **Thunk,
+ IN UINT32 Flags
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Create an IA32 thunk for the given EBC entry point.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle - Handle of image for which this thunk is being created
+ EbcEntryPoint - Address of the EBC code that the thunk is to call
+ Thunk - Returned thunk we create here
+
+Returns:
+
+ Standard EFI status.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINT8 *ThunkBase;
+ UINT32 I;
+ UINT64 Addr;
+ INT32 Size;
+ INT32 ThunkSize;
+
+ //
+ // Check alignment of pointer to EBC code
+ //
+ if ((UINT32) (UINTN) EbcEntryPoint & 0x01) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ Size = EBC_THUNK_SIZE;
+ ThunkSize = Size;
+
+ Ptr = AllocatePool (Size);
+
+ if (Ptr == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Print(L"Allocate TH: 0x%X\n", (UINT32)Ptr);
+ //
+ // Save the start address so we can add a pointer to it to a list later.
+ //
+ ThunkBase = Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Give them the address of our buffer we're going to fix up
+ //
+ *Thunk = (VOID *) Ptr;
+
+ //
+ // Add a magic code here to help the VM recognize the thunk..
+ // mov rax, ca112ebccall2ebch => 48 B8 BC 2E 11 CA BC 2E 11 CA
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0x48;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xB8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ Addr = (UINT64) 0xCA112EBCCA112EBCULL;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) (UINTN) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Add code bytes to load up a processor register with the EBC entry point.
+ // mov rax, 123456789abcdef0h => 48 B8 F0 DE BC 9A 78 56 34 12
+ // The first 8 bytes of the thunk entry is the address of the EBC
+ // entry point.
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0x48;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xB8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ Addr = (UINT64) EbcEntryPoint;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) (UINTN) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // Stick in a load of ecx with the address of appropriate VM function.
+ // Using r11 because it's a volatile register and won't be used in this
+ // point.
+ // mov r11 123456789abcdef0h => 49 BB F0 DE BC 9A 78 56 34 12
+ //
+ if (Flags & FLAG_THUNK_ENTRY_POINT) {
+ Addr = (UINTN) ExecuteEbcImageEntryPoint;
+ } else {
+ Addr = (UINTN) EbcInterpret;
+ }
+
+ //
+ // mov r11 Addr => 0x49 0xBB
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0x49;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xBB;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ for (I = 0; I < sizeof (Addr); I++) {
+ *Ptr = (UINT8) Addr;
+ Addr >>= 8;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ }
+ //
+ // Stick in jump opcode bytes for jmp r11 => 0x41 0xFF 0xE3
+ //
+ *Ptr = 0x41;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xFF;
+ Ptr++;
+ Size--;
+ *Ptr = 0xE3;
+ Size--;
+
+ //
+ // Double check that our defined size is ok (application error)
+ //
+ if (Size < 0) {
+ ASSERT (FALSE);
+ return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
+ }
+ //
+ // Add the thunk to the list for this image. Do this last since the add
+ // function flushes the cache for us.
+ //
+ EbcAddImageThunk (ImageHandle, (VOID *) ThunkBase, ThunkSize);
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+VOID
+EbcLLCALLEX (
+ IN VM_CONTEXT *VmPtr,
+ IN UINTN FuncAddr,
+ IN UINTN NewStackPointer,
+ IN VOID *FramePtr,
+ IN UINT8 Size
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ This function is called to execute an EBC CALLEX instruction.
+ The function check the callee's content to see whether it is common native
+ code or a thunk to another piece of EBC code.
+ If the callee is common native code, use EbcLLCAllEXASM to manipulate,
+ otherwise, set the VM->IP to target EBC code directly to avoid another VM
+ be startup which cost time and stack space.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ VmPtr - Pointer to a VM context.
+ FuncAddr - Callee's address
+ NewStackPointer - New stack pointer after the call
+ FramePtr - New frame pointer after the call
+ Size - The size of call instruction
+
+Returns:
+
+ None.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN IsThunk;
+ UINTN TargetEbcAddr;
+
+ IsThunk = 1;
+ TargetEbcAddr = 0;
+
+ //
+ // Processor specific code to check whether the callee is a thunk to EBC.
+ //
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr) != 0x48) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 1) != 0xB8) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 2) != 0xBC) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 3) != 0x2E) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 4) != 0x11) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 5) != 0xCA) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 6) != 0xBC) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 7) != 0x2E) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 8) != 0x11) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 9) != 0xCA) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 10) != 0x48) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+ if (*((UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 11) != 0xB8) {
+ IsThunk = 0;
+ goto Action;
+ }
+
+ CopyMem (&TargetEbcAddr, (UINT8 *)FuncAddr + 12, 8);
+
+Action:
+ if (IsThunk == 1){
+ //
+ // The callee is a thunk to EBC, adjust the stack pointer down 16 bytes and
+ // put our return address and frame pointer on the VM stack.
+ // Then set the VM's IP to new EBC code.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMemN (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINTN) FramePtr);
+ VmPtr->FramePtr = (VOID *) (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0];
+ VmPtr->R[0] -= 8;
+ VmWriteMem64 (VmPtr, (UINTN) VmPtr->R[0], (UINT64) (VmPtr->Ip + Size));
+
+ VmPtr->Ip = (VMIP) (UINTN) TargetEbcAddr;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // The callee is not a thunk to EBC, call native code.
+ //
+ EbcLLCALLEXNative (FuncAddr, NewStackPointer, FramePtr);
+
+ //
+ // Get return value and advance the IP.
+ //
+ VmPtr->R[7] = EbcLLGetReturnValue ();
+ VmPtr->Ip += Size;
+ }
+}
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..38fe11d --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.c @@ -0,0 +1,931 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+
+Module Name:
+
+ FtwLite.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ This is a simple fault tolerant write driver, based on PlatformFd library.
+ And it only supports write BufferSize <= SpareAreaLength.
+
+ This boot service only protocol provides fault tolerant write capability for
+ block devices. The protocol has internal non-volatile intermediate storage
+ of the data and private information. It should be able to recover
+ automatically from a critical fault, such as power failure.
+
+Notes:
+
+ The implementation uses an FTW Lite (Fault Tolerant Write) Work Space.
+ This work space is a memory copy of the work space on the Woring Block,
+ the size of the work space is the FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE bytes.
+
+--*/
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+//
+// In write function, we should check the target range to prevent the user
+// from writing Spare block and Working space directly.
+//
+//
+// Fault Tolerant Write Protocol API
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+FtwLiteWrite (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE FvbHandle,
+ IN EFI_LBA Lba,
+ IN UINTN Offset,
+ IN OUT UINTN *NumBytes,
+ IN VOID *Buffer
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Starts a target block update. This function will record data about write
+ in fault tolerant storage and will complete the write in a recoverable
+ manner, ensuring at all times that either the original contents or
+ the modified contents are available.
+
+Arguments:
+ This - Calling context
+ FvbHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+ Lba - The logical block address of the target block.
+ Offset - The offset within the target block to place the data.
+ NumBytes - The number of bytes to write to the target block.
+ Buffer - The data to write.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_BAD_BUFFER_SIZE - The write would span a target block, which is not
+ a valid action.
+ EFI_ACCESS_DENIED - No writes have been allocated.
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - Cannot find FVB by handle.
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Cannot allocate memory.
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS FvbPhysicalAddress;
+ UINTN MyLength;
+ UINTN MyOffset;
+ UINTN MyBufferSize;
+ UINT8 *MyBuffer;
+ UINTN SpareBufferSize;
+ UINT8 *SpareBuffer;
+ UINTN Index;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ EFI_DEV_PATH_PTR DevPtr;
+
+ //
+ // Refresh work space and get last record
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice = FTW_LITE_CONTEXT_FROM_THIS (This);
+ Status = WorkSpaceRefresh (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+
+ //
+ // Check the flags of last write record
+ //
+ if ((Record->WriteAllocated == FTW_VALID_STATE) || (Record->SpareCompleted == FTW_VALID_STATE)) {
+ return EFI_ACCESS_DENIED;
+ }
+ //
+ // IF former record has completed, THEN use next record
+ //
+ if (Record->WriteCompleted == FTW_VALID_STATE) {
+ Record++;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord = Record;
+ }
+
+ MyOffset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+
+ //
+ // Check if the input data can fit within the target block
+ //
+ if ((Offset +*NumBytes) > FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength) {
+ return EFI_BAD_BUFFER_SIZE;
+ }
+ //
+ // Check if there is enough free space for allocate a record
+ //
+ if ((MyOffset + WRITE_TOTAL_SIZE) > FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize) {
+ Status = FtwReclaimWorkSpace (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Reclaim work space - %r", Status));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Get the FVB protocol by handle
+ //
+ Status = FtwGetFvbByHandle (FvbHandle, &Fvb);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ }
+ //
+ // Allocate a write record in workspace.
+ // Update Header->WriteAllocated as VALID
+ //
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + MyOffset,
+ WRITE_ALLOCATED
+ );
+
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Allocate record - %r\n", Status));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Record->WriteAllocated = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+
+ //
+ // Prepare data of write record, filling DevPath with memory mapped address.
+ //
+ DevPtr.MemMap = (MEMMAP_DEVICE_PATH *) &Record->DevPath;
+ DevPtr.MemMap->Header.Type = HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH;
+ DevPtr.MemMap->Header.SubType = HW_MEMMAP_DP;
+ SetDevicePathNodeLength (&DevPtr.MemMap->Header, sizeof (MEMMAP_DEVICE_PATH));
+
+ Status = Fvb->GetPhysicalAddress (Fvb, &FvbPhysicalAddress);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Get FVB physical address - %r\n", Status));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ DevPtr.MemMap->MemoryType = EfiMemoryMappedIO;
+ DevPtr.MemMap->StartingAddress = FvbPhysicalAddress;
+ DevPtr.MemMap->EndingAddress = FvbPhysicalAddress +*NumBytes;
+ //
+ // ignored!
+ //
+ Record->Lba = Lba;
+ Record->Offset = Offset;
+ Record->NumBytes = *NumBytes;
+
+ //
+ // Write the record to the work space.
+ //
+ MyOffset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ MyLength = FTW_LITE_RECORD_SIZE;
+
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + MyOffset,
+ &MyLength,
+ (UINT8 *) Record
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Record has been written to working block, then write data.
+ //
+ //
+ // Allocate a memory buffer
+ //
+ MyBufferSize = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ MyBuffer = AllocatePool (MyBufferSize);
+ if (MyBuffer == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Starting at Lba, if the number of the rest blocks on Fvb is less
+ // than NumberOfSpareBlock.
+ //
+ //
+ // Read all original data from target block to memory buffer
+ //
+ if (IsInWorkingBlock (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb, Lba)) {
+ //
+ // If target block falls into working block, we must follow the process of
+ // updating working block.
+ //
+ Ptr = MyBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ MyLength = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &MyLength,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += MyLength;
+ }
+ //
+ // Update Offset by adding the offset from the start LBA of working block to
+ // the target LBA. The target block can not span working block!
+ //
+ Offset = (((UINTN) (Lba - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba)) * FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock + Offset);
+ ASSERT ((Offset +*NumBytes) <= FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength);
+
+ } else {
+
+ Ptr = MyBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ MyLength = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = Fvb->Read (Fvb, Lba + Index, 0, &MyLength, Ptr);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += MyLength;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Overwrite the updating range data with
+ // the input buffer content
+ //
+ CopyMem (MyBuffer + Offset, Buffer, *NumBytes);
+
+ //
+ // Try to keep the content of spare block
+ // Save spare block into a spare backup memory buffer (Sparebuffer)
+ //
+ SpareBufferSize = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ SpareBuffer = AllocatePool (SpareBufferSize);
+ if (SpareBuffer == NULL) {
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ Ptr = SpareBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ MyLength = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &MyLength,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += MyLength;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write the memory buffer to spare block
+ // Don't forget to erase Flash first.
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ Ptr = MyBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ MyLength = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &MyLength,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += MyLength;
+ }
+ //
+ // Free MyBuffer
+ //
+ FreePool (MyBuffer);
+
+ //
+ // Set the SpareCompleteD in the FTW record,
+ //
+ MyOffset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + MyOffset,
+ SPARE_COMPLETED
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Record->SpareCompleted = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+
+ //
+ // Since the content has already backuped in spare block, the write is
+ // guaranteed to be completed with fault tolerant manner.
+ //
+ Status = FtwWriteRecord (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Record++;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord = Record;
+
+ //
+ // Restore spare backup buffer into spare block , if no failure happened during FtwWrite.
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ Ptr = SpareBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ MyLength = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &MyLength,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += MyLength;
+ }
+ //
+ // All success.
+ //
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+
+ DEBUG (
+ (EFI_D_FTW_LITE,
+ "FtwLite: Write() success, (Lba:Offset)=(%lx:0x%x), NumBytes: 0x%x\n",
+ Lba,
+ Offset,
+ *NumBytes)
+ );
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwWriteRecord (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Write a record with fault tolerant mannaer.
+ Since the content has already backuped in spare block, the write is
+ guaranteed to be completed with fault tolerant manner.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ Fvb - The FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+ EFI_LBA WorkSpaceLbaOffset;
+ UINTN Offset;
+
+ //
+ // Spare Complete but Destination not complete,
+ // Recover the targt block with the spare block.
+ //
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+
+ //
+ // IF target block is working block, THEN Flush Spare Block To Working Block;
+ // ELSE IF target block is boot block, THEN Flush Spare Block To boot Block;
+ // ELSE flush spare block to normal target block.ENDIF
+ //
+ if (IsInWorkingBlock (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb, Record->Lba)) {
+ //
+ // If target block is working block, Attention:
+ // it's required to set SPARE_COMPLETED to spare block.
+ //
+ WorkSpaceLbaOffset = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba;
+ Offset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + WorkSpaceLbaOffset,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + Offset,
+ SPARE_COMPLETED
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ Status = FlushSpareBlockToWorkingBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ } else if (IsBootBlock (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb, Record->Lba)) {
+ //
+ // Update boot block
+ //
+ Status = FlushSpareBlockToBootBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Update blocks other than working block or boot block
+ //
+ Status = FlushSpareBlockToTargetBlock (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb, Record->Lba);
+ }
+
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ //
+ // Set WriteCompleted flag in record
+ //
+ Offset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + Offset,
+ WRITE_COMPLETED
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ Record->WriteCompleted = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwRestart (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Restarts a previously interrupted write. The caller must provide the
+ block protocol needed to complete the interrupted write.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ FvbHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ACCESS_DENIED - No pending writes exist
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - FVB protocol not found by the handle
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb;
+ EFI_DEV_PATH_PTR DevPathPtr;
+
+ //
+ // Spare Completed but Destination not complete,
+ // Recover the targt block with the spare block.
+ //
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+
+ //
+ // Only support memory mapped FVB device path by now.
+ //
+ DevPathPtr.MemMap = (MEMMAP_DEVICE_PATH *) &Record->DevPath;
+ if (!((DevPathPtr.MemMap->Header.Type == HARDWARE_DEVICE_PATH) && (DevPathPtr.MemMap->Header.SubType == HW_MEMMAP_DP))
+ ) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: FVB Device Path is not memory mapped\n"));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Status = GetFvbByAddress (DevPathPtr.MemMap->StartingAddress, &Fvb);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ }
+ //
+ // Since the content has already backuped in spare block, the write is
+ // guaranteed to be completed with fault tolerant manner.
+ //
+ Status = FtwWriteRecord (FtwLiteDevice, Fvb);
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_INFO, "FtwLite: Restart() - %r\n", Status));
+
+ Record++;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord = Record;
+
+ //
+ // Erase Spare block
+ // This is restart, no need to keep spareblock content.
+ //
+ FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwAbort (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Aborts all previous allocated writes.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - No allocated writes exist.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Offset;
+
+ if (FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->WriteCompleted == FTW_VALID_STATE) {
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ }
+ //
+ // Update the complete state of the header as VALID and abort.
+ //
+ Offset = (UINT8 *) FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + Offset,
+ WRITE_COMPLETED
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->WriteCompleted = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+
+ Status = FtwGetLastRecord (FtwLiteDevice, &FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord);
+
+ //
+ // Erase the spare block
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_INFO, "FtwLite: Abort() success \n"));
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeFtwLite (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+ Routine Description:
+ This function is the entry point of the Fault Tolerant Write driver.
+
+ Arguments:
+ ImageHandle - EFI_HANDLE: A handle for the image that is initializing
+ this driver
+ SystemTable - EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE: A pointer to the EFI system table
+
+ Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - FTW has finished the initialization
+ EFI_ABORTED - FTW initialization error
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb;
+ UINTN Index;
+ EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
+ UINTN HandleCount;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_HEADER *FwVolHeader;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS BaseAddress;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+ UINTN Length;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Offset;
+ EFI_FV_BLOCK_MAP_ENTRY *FvbMapEntry;
+ UINT32 LbaIndex;
+
+ //
+ // Allocate Private data of this driver,
+ // INCLUDING THE FtwWorkSpace[FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE].
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice = NULL;
+ FtwLiteDevice = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE) + FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE);
+ if (FtwLiteDevice != NULL) {
+ Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
+ } else {
+ Status = EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ ZeroMem (FtwLiteDevice, sizeof (EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE));
+ FtwLiteDevice->Signature = FTW_LITE_DEVICE_SIGNATURE;
+
+ //
+ // Initialize other parameters, and set WorkSpace as FTW_ERASED_BYTE.
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace = (UINT8 *) (FtwLiteDevice + 1);
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize = FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE;
+ SetMem (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize,
+ FTW_ERASED_BYTE
+ );
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader = (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *) FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord = NULL;
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceAddress = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) PcdGet32 (PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingBase);
+ FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceLength = (UINTN) PcdGet32 (PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingSize);
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaAddress = (EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS) PcdGet32 (PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareBase);
+ FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength = (UINTN) PcdGet32 (PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareSize);
+
+ ASSERT ((FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceLength != 0) && (FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength != 0));
+
+ //
+ // Locate FVB protocol
+ //
+ Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
+ ByProtocol,
+ &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid,
+ NULL,
+ &HandleCount,
+ &HandleBuffer
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ ASSERT (HandleCount > 0);
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock = NULL;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb = NULL;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba = (EFI_LBA) (-1);
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba = (EFI_LBA) (-1);
+ for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index += 1) {
+ Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid,
+ (VOID **) &Fvb
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ Status = Fvb->GetPhysicalAddress (Fvb, &BaseAddress);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ FwVolHeader = (EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_HEADER *) ((UINTN) BaseAddress);
+
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceAddress >= BaseAddress) &&
+ (FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceAddress <= (BaseAddress + FwVolHeader->FvLength))
+ ) {
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock = Fvb;
+ //
+ // To get the LBA of work space
+ //
+ if ((FwVolHeader->FvLength) > (FwVolHeader->HeaderLength)) {
+ //
+ // FV may have multiple types of BlockLength
+ //
+ FvbMapEntry = &FwVolHeader->BlockMap[0];
+ while (!((FvbMapEntry->NumBlocks == 0) && (FvbMapEntry->Length == 0))) {
+ for (LbaIndex = 1; LbaIndex <= FvbMapEntry->NumBlocks; LbaIndex += 1) {
+ if (FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceAddress < (BaseAddress + FvbMapEntry->Length * LbaIndex)) {
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba = LbaIndex - 1;
+ //
+ // Get the Work space size and Base(Offset)
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize = FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceLength;
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase = (UINTN) (FtwLiteDevice->WorkSpaceAddress - (BaseAddress + FvbMapEntry->Length * (LbaIndex - 1)));
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // end for
+ //
+ FvbMapEntry++;
+ }
+ //
+ // end while
+ //
+ }
+ }
+
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaAddress >= BaseAddress) &&
+ (FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaAddress <= (BaseAddress + FwVolHeader->FvLength))
+ ) {
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb = Fvb;
+ //
+ // To get the LBA of spare
+ //
+ if ((FwVolHeader->FvLength) > (FwVolHeader->HeaderLength)) {
+ //
+ // FV may have multiple types of BlockLength
+ //
+ FvbMapEntry = &FwVolHeader->BlockMap[0];
+ while (!((FvbMapEntry->NumBlocks == 0) && (FvbMapEntry->Length == 0))) {
+ for (LbaIndex = 1; LbaIndex <= FvbMapEntry->NumBlocks; LbaIndex += 1) {
+ if (FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaAddress < (BaseAddress + FvbMapEntry->Length * LbaIndex)) {
+ //
+ // Get the NumberOfSpareBlock and SizeOfSpareBlock
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba = LbaIndex - 1;
+ FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock = FvbMapEntry->Length;
+ FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength / FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ //
+ // Check the range of spare area to make sure that it's in FV range
+ //
+ ASSERT ((FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock) <= FvbMapEntry->NumBlocks);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ FvbMapEntry++;
+ }
+ //
+ // end while
+ //
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Calculate the start LBA of working block. Working block is an area which
+ // contains working space in its last block and has the same size as spare
+ // block, unless there are not enough blocks before the block that contains
+ // working space.
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba - FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock + 1;
+ if ((INT64) (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba) < 0) {
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba = 0;
+ }
+
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock == NULL) ||
+ (FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb == NULL) ||
+ (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba == (EFI_LBA) (-1)) ||
+ (FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba == (EFI_LBA) (-1))
+ ) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Working or spare FVB not ready\n"));
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+ }
+ //
+ // Refresh workspace data from working block
+ //
+ Status = WorkSpaceRefresh (FtwLiteDevice);
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ //
+ // If the working block workspace is not valid, try the spare block
+ //
+ if (!IsValidWorkSpace (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Workspace invalid, read from backup\n"));
+ //
+ // Read from spare block
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase,
+ &Length,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ //
+ // If spare block is valid, then replace working block content.
+ //
+ if (IsValidWorkSpace (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader)) {
+ Status = FlushSpareBlockToWorkingBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Restart working block in Init() - %r\n", Status));
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ FtwAbort (FtwLiteDevice);
+ //
+ // Refresh work space.
+ //
+ Status = WorkSpaceRefresh (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ } else {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Both are invalid, init workspace\n"));
+ //
+ // If both are invalid, then initialize work space.
+ //
+ SetMem (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize,
+ FTW_ERASED_BYTE
+ );
+ InitWorkSpaceHeader (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader);
+ //
+ // Write to work space on the working block
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase,
+ &Length,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // Hook the protocol API
+ //
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwLiteInstance.Write = FtwLiteWrite;
+
+ //
+ // Install protocol interface
+ //
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (
+ &FtwLiteDevice->Handle,
+ &gEfiFaultTolerantWriteLiteProtocolGuid,
+ EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
+ &FtwLiteDevice->FtwLiteInstance
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // If (!SpareCompleted) THEN Abort to rollback.
+ //
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->WriteAllocated == FTW_VALID_STATE) &&
+ (FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->SpareCompleted != FTW_VALID_STATE)
+ ) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Init.. record not SpareCompleted, abort()\n"));
+ FtwAbort (FtwLiteDevice);
+ }
+ //
+ // if (SpareCompleted) THEN Restart to fault tolerant write.
+ //
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->SpareCompleted == FTW_VALID_STATE) &&
+ (FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord->WriteCompleted != FTW_VALID_STATE)
+ ) {
+
+ Status = FtwRestart (FtwLiteDevice);
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Restart last write - %r\n", Status));
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return Status;
+ }
+ }
+ //
+ // To check the workspace buffer behind last records is EMPTY or not.
+ // If it's not EMPTY, FTW_LITE also need to call reclaim().
+ //
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+ Offset = (UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+ if (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace[Offset] != FTW_ERASED_BYTE) {
+ Offset += WRITE_TOTAL_SIZE;
+ }
+
+ if (!IsErasedFlashBuffer (
+ FTW_ERASE_POLARITY,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace + Offset,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize - Offset
+ )) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Workspace is dirty, call reclaim...\n"));
+ Status = FtwReclaimWorkSpace (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Workspace reclaim - %r\n", Status));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.dxs b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.dxs new file mode 100644 index 0000000..93aa216 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.dxs @@ -0,0 +1,27 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+
+Module Name:
+
+ FtwLite.dxs
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Dependency expression source file.
+
+--*/
+#include <DxeDepex.h>
+
+
+DEPENDENCY_START
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL_GUID AND EFI_ALTERNATE_FV_BLOCK_GUID
+DEPENDENCY_END
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..8bc122d --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.h @@ -0,0 +1,695 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+
+Module Name:
+
+ FtwLite.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ This is a simple fault tolerant write driver, based on PlatformFd library.
+ And it only supports write BufferSize <= SpareAreaLength.
+
+ This boot service only protocol provides fault tolerant write capability for
+ block devices. The protocol has internal non-volatile intermediate storage
+ of the data and private information. It should be able to recover
+ automatically from a critical fault, such as power failure.
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WRITE_LITE_H_
+#define _EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WRITE_LITE_H_
+
+//
+// The package level header files this module uses
+//
+#include <PiDxe.h>
+//
+// The protocols, PPI and GUID defintions for this module
+//
+#include <Protocol/PciRootBridgeIo.h>
+#include <Guid/SystemNvDataGuid.h>
+#include <Protocol/FaultTolerantWriteLite.h>
+#include <Protocol/FirmwareVolumeBlock.h>
+//
+// The Library classes this module consumes
+//
+#include <Library/PcdLib.h>
+#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiDriverEntryPoint.h>
+#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
+#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
+
+#include <Common/WorkingBlockHeader.h>
+
+#define EFI_D_FTW_LITE EFI_D_ERROR
+#define EFI_D_FTW_INFO EFI_D_INFO
+
+//
+// Flash erase polarity is 1
+//
+#define FTW_ERASE_POLARITY 1
+
+#define FTW_VALID_STATE 0
+#define FTW_INVALID_STATE 1
+
+#define FTW_ERASED_BYTE ((UINT8) (255))
+#define FTW_POLARITY_REVERT ((UINT8) (255))
+
+typedef struct {
+ UINT8 WriteAllocated : 1;
+ UINT8 SpareCompleted : 1;
+ UINT8 WriteCompleted : 1;
+ UINT8 Reserved : 5;
+#define WRITE_ALLOCATED 0x1
+#define SPARE_COMPLETED 0x2
+#define WRITE_COMPLETED 0x4
+
+ EFI_DEV_PATH DevPath;
+ EFI_LBA Lba;
+ UINTN Offset;
+ UINTN NumBytes;
+ //
+ // UINTN SpareAreaOffset;
+ //
+} EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD;
+
+#define FTW_LITE_DEVICE_SIGNATURE EFI_SIGNATURE_32 ('F', 'T', 'W', 'L')
+
+//
+// MACRO for Block size.
+// Flash Erasing will do in block granularity.
+//
+#ifdef FV_BLOCK_SIZE
+#define FTW_BLOCK_SIZE FV_BLOCK_SIZE
+#else
+#define FV_BLOCK_SIZE 0x10000
+#define FTW_BLOCK_SIZE FV_BLOCK_SIZE
+#endif
+//
+// MACRO for FTW WORK SPACE Base & Size
+//
+#ifdef EFI_FTW_WORKING_OFFSET
+#define FTW_WORK_SPACE_BASE EFI_FTW_WORKING_OFFSET
+#else
+#define FTW_WORK_SPACE_BASE 0x00E000
+#endif
+
+#ifdef EFI_FTW_WORKING_LENGTH
+#define FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE EFI_FTW_WORKING_LENGTH
+#else
+#define FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE 0x002000
+#endif
+//
+// MACRO for FTW header and record
+//
+#define FTW_WORKING_QUEUE_SIZE (FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE - sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER))
+#define FTW_LITE_RECORD_SIZE (sizeof (EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD))
+#define WRITE_TOTAL_SIZE FTW_LITE_RECORD_SIZE
+
+//
+// EFI Fault tolerant protocol private data structure
+//
+typedef struct {
+ UINTN Signature;
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_PROTOCOL FtwLiteInstance;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS WorkSpaceAddress;
+ UINTN WorkSpaceLength;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS SpareAreaAddress;
+ UINTN SpareAreaLength;
+ UINTN NumberOfSpareBlock; // Number of the blocks in spare block
+ UINTN SizeOfSpareBlock; // Block size in bytes of the blocks in spare block
+ EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *FtwWorkSpaceHeader;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *FtwLastRecord;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FtwFvBlock; // FVB of working block
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FtwBackupFvb; // FVB of spare block
+ EFI_LBA FtwSpareLba;
+ EFI_LBA FtwWorkBlockLba; // Start LBA of working block
+ EFI_LBA FtwWorkSpaceLba; // Start LBA of working space
+ UINTN FtwWorkSpaceBase; // Offset from LBA start addr
+ UINTN FtwWorkSpaceSize;
+ UINT8 *FtwWorkSpace;
+ //
+ // Following a buffer of FtwWorkSpace[FTW_WORK_SPACE_SIZE],
+ // Allocated with EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE.
+ //
+} EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE;
+
+#define FTW_LITE_CONTEXT_FROM_THIS(a) CR (a, EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE, FtwLiteInstance, FTW_LITE_DEVICE_SIGNATURE)
+
+//
+// Driver entry point
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeFtwLite (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ This function is the entry point of the Fault Tolerant Write driver.
+
+Arguments:
+ ImageHandle - EFI_HANDLE: A handle for the image that is initializing
+ this driver
+ SystemTable - EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE: A pointer to the EFI system table
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - FTW has finished the initialization
+ EFI_ABORTED - FTW initialization error
+
+--*/
+;
+
+//
+// Fault Tolerant Write Protocol API
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+FtwLiteWrite (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_HANDLE FvbHandle,
+ IN EFI_LBA Lba,
+ IN UINTN Offset,
+ IN UINTN *NumBytes,
+ IN VOID *Buffer
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Starts a target block update. This function will record data about write
+ in fault tolerant storage and will complete the write in a recoverable
+ manner, ensuring at all times that either the original contents or
+ the modified contents are available.
+
+Arguments:
+ This - Calling context
+ FvbHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+ Lba - The logical block address of the target block.
+ Offset - The offset within the target block to place the data.
+ NumBytes - The number of bytes to write to the target block.
+ Buffer - The data to write.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_BAD_BUFFER_SIZE - The write would span a target block, which is not
+ a valid action.
+ EFI_ACCESS_DENIED - No writes have been allocated.
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - Cannot find FVB by handle.
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Cannot allocate memory.
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+//
+// Internal functions
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwRestart (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Restarts a previously interrupted write. The caller must provide the
+ block protocol needed to complete the interrupted write.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ FvbHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ACCESS_DENIED - No pending writes exist
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - FVB protocol not found by the handle
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwAbort (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Aborts all previous allocated writes.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - No allocated writes exist.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwWriteRecord (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Write a record with fault tolerant mannaer.
+ Since the content has already backuped in spare block, the write is
+ guaranteed to be completed with fault tolerant manner.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ Fvb - The FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwEraseBlock (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ To Erase one block. The size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface
+ Lba - Lba of the firmware block
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Block LBA is Erased successfully
+ Others - Error occurs
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwEraseSpareBlock (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Erase spare block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Status code
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwGetFvbByHandle (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE FvBlockHandle,
+ OUT EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL **FvBlock
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Retrive the proper FVB protocol interface by HANDLE.
+
+Arguments:
+ FvBlockHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+ FvBlock - The interface of FVB protocol
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+GetFvbByAddress (
+ IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Address,
+ OUT EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL **FvBlock
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Get firmware block by address.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Address - Address specified the block
+ FvBlock - The block caller wanted
+
+Returns:
+
+ Status code
+
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - Block not found
+
+--*/
+;
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsInWorkingBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Is it in working block?
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - The block specified
+
+Returns:
+
+ In working block or not
+
+--*/
+;
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether the block is a boot block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - Lba value
+
+Returns:
+
+ Is a boot block or not
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToTargetBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a target block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Target block is accessed by FvBlock protocol interface. LBA is Lba.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface to access target block
+ Lba - Lba of the target block
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to target block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToWorkingBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to working block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Working block is accessed by FTW working FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to target block
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+ Since the working block header is important when FTW initializes, the
+ state of the operation should be handled carefully. The Crc value is
+ calculated without STATE element.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a boot block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Boot block is accessed by BootFvb protocol interface. LBA is 0.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to boot block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwUpdateFvState (
+ IN EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ IN EFI_LBA Lba,
+ IN UINTN Offset,
+ IN UINT8 NewBit
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Update a bit of state on a block device. The location of the bit is
+ calculated by the (Lba, Offset, bit). Here bit is determined by the
+ the name of a certain bit.
+
+Arguments:
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface to access SrcBlock and DestBlock
+ Lba - Lba of a block
+ Offset - Offset on the Lba
+ NewBit - New value that will override the old value if it can be change
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - A state bit has been updated successfully
+ Others - Access block device error.
+
+Notes:
+ Assume all bits of State are inside the same BYTE.
+
+ EFI_ABORTED - Read block fail
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwGetLastRecord (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ OUT EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD **FtwLastRecord
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Get the last Write record pointer.
+ The last record is the record whose 'complete' state hasn't been set.
+ After all, this header may be a EMPTY header entry for next Allocate.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Private data of this driver
+ FtwLastRecord - Pointer to retrieve the last write record
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Get the last write record successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The FTW work space is damaged
+
+--*/
+;
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsErasedFlashBuffer (
+ IN BOOLEAN Polarity,
+ IN UINT8 *Buffer,
+ IN UINTN BufferSize
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether a flash buffer is erased.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Polarity - All 1 or all 0
+ Buffer - Buffer to check
+ BufferSize - Size of the buffer
+
+Returns:
+
+ Erased or not.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+InitWorkSpaceHeader (
+ IN EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingHeader
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Initialize a work space when there is no work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ WorkingHeader - Pointer of working block header
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+WorkSpaceRefresh (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Read from working block to refresh the work space in memory.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsValidWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingHeader
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Check to see if it is a valid work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ WorkingHeader - Pointer of working block header
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+CleanupWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN OUT UINT8 *BlockBuffer,
+ IN UINTN BufferSize
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Reclaim the work space. Get rid of all the completed write records
+ and write records in the Fault Tolerant work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+ FtwSpaceBuffer - Buffer to contain the reclaimed clean data
+ BufferSize - Size of the FtwSpaceBuffer
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL - The FtwSpaceBuffer is too small
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwReclaimWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Reclaim the work space on the working block.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+;
+
+#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000..39422f2 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.inf @@ -0,0 +1,133 @@ +#/** @file
+# Component description file for FtwLite module.
+#
+# This driver provides fault tolerant write capability for block devices.
+# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+#
+# All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#
+#
+#**/
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Defines Section - statements that will be processed to create a Makefile.
+#
+################################################################################
+[Defines]
+ INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
+ BASE_NAME = FtwLite
+ FILE_GUID = 4C862FC6-0E54-4e36-8C8F-FF6F3167951F
+ MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
+ VERSION_STRING = 1.0
+ EDK_RELEASE_VERSION = 0x00020000
+ EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x00020000
+
+ ENTRY_POINT = InitializeFtwLite
+
+#
+# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
+#
+# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
+#
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Sources Section - list of files that are required for the build to succeed.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Sources.common]
+ FtwLite.dxs
+ FtwWorkSpace.c
+ FtwMisc.c
+ FtwLite.c
+ FtwLite.h
+
+[Sources.Ia32]
+ Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c
+
+[Sources.X64]
+ x64/x64FtwMisc.c
+
+[Sources.IPF]
+ Ipf/IpfFtwMisc.c
+
+[Sources.EBC]
+ Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Package Dependency Section - list of Package files that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Packages]
+ MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
+ MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
+
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Library Class Section - list of Library Classes that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[LibraryClasses]
+ UefiBootServicesTableLib
+ MemoryAllocationLib
+ BaseMemoryLib
+ UefiDriverEntryPoint
+ DebugLib
+ PcdLib
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Guid C Name Section - list of Guids that this module uses or produces.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Guids]
+ gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid # ALWAYS_CONSUMED
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Protocol C Name Section - list of Protocol and Protocol Notify C Names
+# that this module uses or produces.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Protocols]
+ gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_CONSUMED
+ gEfiFaultTolerantWriteLiteProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_PRODUCED
+
+[Protocols.IA32]
+ gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_CONSUMED
+
+[Protocols.EBC]
+ gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_CONSUMED
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Pcd DYNAMIC - list of PCDs that this module is coded for.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[PcdsDynamic.common]
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingSize|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingBase|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareSize|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid
+ PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareBase|gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.msa b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.msa new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7362f47 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwLite.msa @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
+<ModuleSurfaceArea xmlns="http://www.TianoCore.org/2006/Edk2.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance">
+ <MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleName>FtwLite</ModuleName>
+ <ModuleType>DXE_DRIVER</ModuleType>
+ <GuidValue>4C862FC6-0E54-4e36-8C8F-FF6F3167951F</GuidValue>
+ <Version>1.0</Version>
+ <Abstract>Component description file for FtwLite module.</Abstract>
+ <Description>This driver provides fault tolerant write capability for block devices.</Description>
+ <Copyright>Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation</Copyright>
+ <License>All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+ are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+ which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+ http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+ THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+ WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.</License>
+ <Specification>FRAMEWORK_BUILD_PACKAGING_SPECIFICATION 0x00000052</Specification>
+ </MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleDefinitions>
+ <SupportedArchitectures>IA32 X64 IPF EBC</SupportedArchitectures>
+ <BinaryModule>false</BinaryModule>
+ <OutputFileBasename>FtwLite</OutputFileBasename>
+ </ModuleDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>PcdLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>DebugLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiDriverEntryPoint</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>BaseMemoryLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>MemoryAllocationLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiBootServicesTableLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ </LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <SourceFiles>
+ <Filename>FtwLite.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>FtwLite.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>FtwMisc.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>FtwWorkSpace.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>FtwLite.dxs</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IA32 EBC">Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="X64">x64/x64FtwMisc.c</Filename>
+ <Filename SupArchList="IPF">Ipf/IpfFtwMisc.c</Filename>
+ </SourceFiles>
+ <PackageDependencies>
+ <Package PackageGuid="1E73767F-8F52-4603-AEB4-F29B510B6766"/>
+ <Package PackageGuid="BA0D78D6-2CAF-414b-BD4D-B6762A894288"/>
+ </PackageDependencies>
+ <Protocols>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_PRODUCED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiFaultTolerantWriteLiteProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED" SupArchList="IA32 EBC">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ </Protocols>
+ <Guids>
+ <GuidCNames Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <GuidCName>gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid</GuidCName>
+ </GuidCNames>
+ </Guids>
+ <Externs>
+ <Specification>EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Specification>EDK_RELEASE_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Extern>
+ <ModuleEntryPoint>InitializeFtwLite</ModuleEntryPoint>
+ </Extern>
+ </Externs>
+ <PcdCoded>
+ <PcdEntry PcdItemType="DYNAMIC" Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <C_Name>PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareBase</C_Name>
+ <TokenSpaceGuidCName>gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid</TokenSpaceGuidCName>
+ <HelpText>To get base address of the FTW spare block section in NV firmware volume.</HelpText>
+ </PcdEntry>
+ <PcdEntry PcdItemType="DYNAMIC" Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <C_Name>PcdFlashNvStorageFtwSpareSize</C_Name>
+ <TokenSpaceGuidCName>gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid</TokenSpaceGuidCName>
+ <HelpText>To get size of the FTW spare block section in NV firmware volume.</HelpText>
+ </PcdEntry>
+ <PcdEntry PcdItemType="DYNAMIC" Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <C_Name>PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingBase</C_Name>
+ <TokenSpaceGuidCName>gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid</TokenSpaceGuidCName>
+ <HelpText>To get base address of the FTW working block section in NV firmware volume.</HelpText>
+ </PcdEntry>
+ <PcdEntry PcdItemType="DYNAMIC" Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <C_Name>PcdFlashNvStorageFtwWorkingSize</C_Name>
+ <TokenSpaceGuidCName>gEfiGenericPlatformTokenSpaceGuid</TokenSpaceGuidCName>
+ <HelpText>To get size of the FTW working block section in NV firmware volume.</HelpText>
+ </PcdEntry>
+ </PcdCoded>
+</ModuleSurfaceArea>
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwMisc.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwMisc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..eb334ea --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwMisc.c @@ -0,0 +1,530 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ FtwMisc.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Internal functions to support fault tolerant write.
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsErasedFlashBuffer (
+ IN BOOLEAN Polarity,
+ IN UINT8 *Buffer,
+ IN UINTN BufferSize
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether a flash buffer is erased.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Polarity - All 1 or all 0
+ Buffer - Buffer to check
+ BufferSize - Size of the buffer
+
+Returns:
+
+ Erased or not.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT8 ErasedValue;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+
+ if (Polarity) {
+ ErasedValue = 0xFF;
+ } else {
+ ErasedValue = 0;
+ }
+
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ while (BufferSize--) {
+ if (*Ptr++ != ErasedValue) {
+ return FALSE;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return TRUE;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwEraseBlock (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ To Erase one block. The size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface
+ Lba - Lba of the firmware block
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Block LBA is Erased successfully
+ Others - Error occurs
+
+--*/
+{
+ return FvBlock->EraseBlocks (
+ FvBlock,
+ Lba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock,
+ EFI_LBA_LIST_TERMINATOR
+ );
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwEraseSpareBlock (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Erase spare block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+
+Returns:
+
+ Status code
+
+--*/
+{
+ return FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->EraseBlocks (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock,
+ EFI_LBA_LIST_TERMINATOR
+ );
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwGetFvbByHandle (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE FvBlockHandle,
+ OUT EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL **FvBlock
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Retrive the proper FVB protocol interface by HANDLE.
+
+Arguments:
+ FvBlockHandle - The handle of FVB protocol that provides services for
+ reading, writing, and erasing the target block.
+ FvBlock - The interface of FVB protocol
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // To get the FVB protocol interface on the handle
+ //
+ return gBS->HandleProtocol (
+ FvBlockHandle,
+ &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid,
+ (VOID **) FvBlock
+ );
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+GetFvbByAddress (
+ IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS Address,
+ OUT EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL **FvBlock
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Get firmware block by address.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Address - Address specified the block
+ FvBlock - The block caller wanted
+
+Returns:
+
+ Status code
+
+ EFI_NOT_FOUND - Block not found
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_HANDLE *HandleBuffer;
+ UINTN HandleCount;
+ UINTN Index;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS FvbBaseAddress;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *Fvb;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_HEADER *FwVolHeader;
+
+ *FvBlock = NULL;
+ //
+ // Locate all handles of Fvb protocol
+ //
+ Status = gBS->LocateHandleBuffer (
+ ByProtocol,
+ &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid,
+ NULL,
+ &HandleCount,
+ &HandleBuffer
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ }
+ //
+ // Search all FVB until find the right one
+ //
+ for (Index = 0; Index < HandleCount; Index += 1) {
+ Status = gBS->HandleProtocol (
+ HandleBuffer[Index],
+ &gEfiFirmwareVolumeBlockProtocolGuid,
+ (VOID **) &Fvb
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ Status = EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+ break;
+ }
+ //
+ // Compare the address and select the right one
+ //
+ Status = Fvb->GetPhysicalAddress (Fvb, &FvbBaseAddress);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ FwVolHeader = (EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_HEADER *) ((UINTN) FvbBaseAddress);
+ if ((Address >= FvbBaseAddress) && (Address <= (FvbBaseAddress + (FwVolHeader->FvLength - 1)))) {
+ *FvBlock = Fvb;
+ Status = EFI_SUCCESS;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ FreePool (HandleBuffer);
+ return Status;
+}
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsInWorkingBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Is it in working block?
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - The block specified
+
+Returns:
+
+ In working block or not
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // If matching the following condition, the target block is in working block.
+ // 1. Target block is on the FV of working block (Using the same FVB protocol instance).
+ // 2. Lba falls into the range of working block.
+ //
+ return (BOOLEAN)
+ (
+ (FvBlock == FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock) &&
+ (Lba >= FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba) &&
+ (Lba <= FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba)
+ );
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToTargetBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a target block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Target block is accessed by FvBlock protocol interface. LBA is Lba.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface to access target block
+ Lba - Lba of the target block
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to target block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Length;
+ UINT8 *Buffer;
+ UINTN Count;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINTN Index;
+
+ if ((FtwLiteDevice == NULL) || (FvBlock == NULL)) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+ //
+ // Allocate a memory buffer
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ Buffer = AllocatePool (Length);
+ if (Buffer == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Read all content of spare block to memory buffer
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+ //
+ // Erase the target block
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseBlock (FtwLiteDevice, FvBlock, Lba);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write memory buffer to block, using the FvbBlock protocol interface
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FvBlock->Write (FvBlock, Lba + Index, 0, &Count, Ptr);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: FVB Write block - %r\n", Status));
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToWorkingBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to working block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Working block is accessed by FTW working FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to target block
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+ Since the working block header is important when FTW initializes, the
+ state of the operation should be handled carefully. The Crc value is
+ calculated without STATE element.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Length;
+ UINT8 *Buffer;
+ EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingBlockHeader;
+ EFI_LBA WorkSpaceLbaOffset;
+ UINTN Count;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINTN Index;
+
+ //
+ // Allocate a memory buffer
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ Buffer = AllocatePool (Length);
+ if (Buffer == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // To guarantee that the WorkingBlockValid is set on spare block
+ //
+ WorkSpaceLbaOffset = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba;
+ FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + WorkSpaceLbaOffset,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + sizeof (EFI_GUID) + sizeof (UINT32),
+ WORKING_BLOCK_VALID
+ );
+ //
+ // Read from spare block to memory buffer
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+ //
+ // Clear the CRC and STATE, copy data from spare to working block.
+ //
+ WorkingBlockHeader = (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *) (Buffer + (UINTN) WorkSpaceLbaOffset * FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock + FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase);
+ InitWorkSpaceHeader (WorkingBlockHeader);
+ WorkingBlockHeader->WorkingBlockValid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+ WorkingBlockHeader->WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+
+ //
+ // target block is working block, then
+ // Set WorkingBlockInvalid in EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER
+ // before erase the working block.
+ //
+ // Offset = EFI_FIELD_OFFSET(EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER,
+ // WorkingBlockInvalid);
+ // To skip Signature and Crc: sizeof(EFI_GUID)+sizeof(UINT32).
+ //
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + sizeof (EFI_GUID) + sizeof (UINT32),
+ WORKING_BLOCK_INVALID
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader->WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+
+ //
+ // Erase the working block
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseBlock (
+ FtwLiteDevice,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write memory buffer to working block, using the FvbBlock protocol interface
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: FVB Write block - %r\n", Status));
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+ //
+ // Since the memory buffer will not be used, free memory Buffer.
+ //
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+
+ //
+ // Update the VALID of the working block
+ //
+ // Offset = EFI_FIELD_OFFSET(EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER,
+ // WorkingBlockValid);
+ // Hardcode offset sizeof(EFI_GUID)+sizeof(UINT32), to skip Signature and Crc
+ //
+ Status = FtwUpdateFvState (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase + sizeof (EFI_GUID) + sizeof (UINT32),
+ WORKING_BLOCK_VALID
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader->WorkingBlockValid = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwWorkSpace.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwWorkSpace.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..00d7d8e --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/FtwWorkSpace.c @@ -0,0 +1,561 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ FtwWorkSpace.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsValidWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingHeader
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Check to see if it is a valid work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ WorkingHeader - Pointer of working block header
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER WorkingBlockHeader;
+
+ ASSERT (WorkingHeader != NULL);
+ if (WorkingHeader->WorkingBlockValid != FTW_VALID_STATE) {
+ return FALSE;
+ }
+ //
+ // Check signature with gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid
+ //
+ if (!CompareGuid (&gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid, &WorkingHeader->Signature)) {
+ return FALSE;
+ }
+ //
+ // Check the CRC of header
+ //
+ CopyMem (
+ &WorkingBlockHeader,
+ WorkingHeader,
+ sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER)
+ );
+
+ //
+ // Filter out the Crc and State fields
+ //
+ SetMem (
+ &WorkingBlockHeader.Crc,
+ sizeof (UINT32),
+ FTW_ERASED_BYTE
+ );
+ WorkingBlockHeader.WorkingBlockValid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+ WorkingBlockHeader.WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+
+ //
+ // Calculate the Crc of woking block header
+ //
+ Status = gBS->CalculateCrc32 (
+ (UINT8 *) &WorkingBlockHeader,
+ sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER),
+ &WorkingBlockHeader.Crc
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ if (WorkingBlockHeader.Crc != WorkingHeader->Crc) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Work block header CRC check error\n"));
+ return FALSE;
+ }
+
+ return TRUE;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+InitWorkSpaceHeader (
+ IN EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingHeader
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Initialize a work space when there is no work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ WorkingHeader - Pointer of working block header
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ ASSERT (WorkingHeader != NULL);
+
+ //
+ // Here using gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid as the signature.
+ //
+ CopyMem (
+ &WorkingHeader->Signature,
+ &gEfiSystemNvDataFvGuid,
+ sizeof (EFI_GUID)
+ );
+ WorkingHeader->WriteQueueSize = FTW_WORKING_QUEUE_SIZE;
+
+ //
+ // Crc is calculated with all the fields except Crc and STATE
+ //
+ WorkingHeader->WorkingBlockValid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+ WorkingHeader->WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_ERASE_POLARITY;
+ SetMem (&WorkingHeader->Crc, sizeof (UINT32), FTW_ERASED_BYTE);
+
+ //
+ // Calculate the CRC value
+ //
+ Status = gBS->CalculateCrc32 (
+ (UINT8 *) WorkingHeader,
+ sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER),
+ &WorkingHeader->Crc
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ //
+ // Restore the WorkingBlockValid flag to VALID state
+ //
+ WorkingHeader->WorkingBlockValid = FTW_VALID_STATE;
+ WorkingHeader->WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_INVALID_STATE;
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwUpdateFvState (
+ IN EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ IN EFI_LBA Lba,
+ IN UINTN Offset,
+ IN UINT8 NewBit
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Update a bit of state on a block device. The location of the bit is
+ calculated by the (Lba, Offset, bit). Here bit is determined by the
+ the name of a certain bit.
+
+Arguments:
+ FvBlock - FVB Protocol interface to access SrcBlock and DestBlock
+ Lba - Lba of a block
+ Offset - Offset on the Lba
+ NewBit - New value that will override the old value if it can be change
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - A state bit has been updated successfully
+ Others - Access block device error.
+
+Notes:
+ Assume all bits of State are inside the same BYTE.
+
+ EFI_ABORTED - Read block fail
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINT8 State;
+ UINTN Length;
+
+ //
+ // Read state from device, assume State is only one byte.
+ //
+ Length = sizeof (UINT8);
+ Status = FvBlock->Read (FvBlock, Lba, Offset, &Length, &State);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ State ^= FTW_POLARITY_REVERT;
+ State = (UINT8) (State | NewBit);
+ State ^= FTW_POLARITY_REVERT;
+
+ //
+ // Write state back to device
+ //
+ Length = sizeof (UINT8);
+ Status = FvBlock->Write (FvBlock, Lba, Offset, &Length, &State);
+
+ return Status;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwGetLastRecord (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ OUT EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD **FtwLastRecord
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Get the last Write record pointer.
+ The last record is the record whose 'complete' state hasn't been set.
+ After all, this header may be a EMPTY header entry for next Allocate.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Private data of this driver
+ FtwLastRecord - Pointer to retrieve the last write record
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Get the last write record successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The FTW work space is damaged
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+
+ Record = (EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *) (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader + 1);
+ while (Record->WriteCompleted == FTW_VALID_STATE) {
+ //
+ // If Offset exceed the FTW work space boudary, return error.
+ //
+ if ((UINTN) ((UINT8 *) Record - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace) > FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Record++;
+ }
+ //
+ // Last write record is found
+ //
+ *FtwLastRecord = Record;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+WorkSpaceRefresh (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Read from working block to refresh the work space in memory.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Length;
+ UINTN Offset;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+
+ //
+ // Initialize WorkSpace as FTW_ERASED_BYTE
+ //
+ SetMem (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize,
+ FTW_ERASED_BYTE
+ );
+
+ //
+ // Read from working block
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase,
+ &Length,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Refresh the FtwLastRecord
+ //
+ Status = FtwGetLastRecord (FtwLiteDevice, &FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord);
+
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+ Offset = (UINTN) (UINT8 *) Record - (UINTN) FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace;
+
+ //
+ // IF work space has error or Record is out of the workspace limit, THEN
+ // call reclaim.
+ //
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status) || (Offset + WRITE_TOTAL_SIZE >= FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize)) {
+ //
+ // reclaim work space in working block.
+ //
+ Status = FtwReclaimWorkSpace (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: Reclaim workspace - %r\n", Status));
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+CleanupWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN OUT UINT8 *FtwSpaceBuffer,
+ IN UINTN BufferSize
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Reclaim the work space. Get rid of all the completed write records
+ and write records in the Fault Tolerant work space.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+ FtwSpaceBuffer - Buffer to contain the reclaimed clean data
+ BufferSize - Size of the FtwSpaceBuffer
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL - The FtwSpaceBuffer is too small
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN Length;
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_RECORD *Record;
+
+ //
+ // To check if the buffer is large enough
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize;
+ if (BufferSize < Length) {
+ return EFI_BUFFER_TOO_SMALL;
+ }
+ //
+ // Clear the content of buffer that will save the new work space data
+ //
+ SetMem (FtwSpaceBuffer, Length, FTW_ERASED_BYTE);
+
+ //
+ // Copy EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER to buffer
+ //
+ CopyMem (
+ FtwSpaceBuffer,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceHeader,
+ sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER)
+ );
+
+ //
+ // Get the last record
+ //
+ Record = FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord;
+ if ((Record != NULL) && (Record->WriteAllocated == FTW_VALID_STATE) && (Record->WriteCompleted != FTW_VALID_STATE)) {
+ CopyMem (
+ (UINT8 *) FtwSpaceBuffer + sizeof (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER),
+ Record,
+ WRITE_TOTAL_SIZE
+ );
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FtwReclaimWorkSpace (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Reclaim the work space on the working block.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Point to private data of FTW driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINT8 *TempBuffer;
+ UINTN TempBufferSize;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINTN Length;
+ UINTN Index;
+ UINTN SpareBufferSize;
+ UINT8 *SpareBuffer;
+ EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *WorkingBlockHeader;
+
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: start to reclaim work space\n"));
+
+ //
+ // Read all original data from working block to a memory buffer
+ //
+ TempBufferSize = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ TempBuffer = AllocateZeroPool (TempBufferSize);
+ if (TempBuffer != NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ Ptr = TempBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwFvBlock,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Length,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (TempBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Length;
+ }
+ //
+ // Clean up the workspace, remove all the completed records.
+ //
+ Ptr = TempBuffer +
+ ((UINTN) (FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceLba - FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkBlockLba)) *
+ FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock + FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceBase;
+
+ Status = CleanupWorkSpace (
+ FtwLiteDevice,
+ Ptr,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize
+ );
+
+ CopyMem (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpace,
+ Ptr,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwWorkSpaceSize
+ );
+
+ Status = FtwGetLastRecord (FtwLiteDevice, &FtwLiteDevice->FtwLastRecord);
+
+ //
+ // Set the WorkingBlockValid and WorkingBlockInvalid as INVALID
+ //
+ WorkingBlockHeader = (EFI_FAULT_TOLERANT_WORKING_BLOCK_HEADER *) Ptr;
+ WorkingBlockHeader->WorkingBlockValid = FTW_INVALID_STATE;
+ WorkingBlockHeader->WorkingBlockInvalid = FTW_INVALID_STATE;
+
+ //
+ // Try to keep the content of spare block
+ // Save spare block into a spare backup memory buffer (Sparebuffer)
+ //
+ SpareBufferSize = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ SpareBuffer = AllocatePool (SpareBufferSize);
+ if (SpareBuffer == NULL) {
+ FreePool (TempBuffer);
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ Ptr = SpareBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Length,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (TempBuffer);
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Length;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write the memory buffer to spare block
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ Ptr = TempBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Length,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (TempBuffer);
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Length;
+ }
+ //
+ // Free TempBuffer
+ //
+ FreePool (TempBuffer);
+
+ //
+ // Write the spare block to working block
+ //
+ Status = FlushSpareBlockToWorkingBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+ //
+ // Restore spare backup buffer into spare block , if no failure happened during FtwWrite.
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ Ptr = SpareBuffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Length,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Length;
+ }
+
+ FreePool (SpareBuffer);
+
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: reclaim work space success\n"));
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..6425f29 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ia32/Ia32FtwMisc.c @@ -0,0 +1,403 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ Ia32FtwMisc.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Ia32 platform related code to support FtwLite..
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+//
+// MACROs for boot block update
+//
+#define BOOT_BLOCK_BASE 0xFFFF0000
+
+//
+// (LPC -- D31:F0)
+//
+#define LPC_BUS_NUMBER 0x00
+#define LPC_DEVICE_NUMBER 0x1F
+#define LPC_IF 0xF0
+//
+// Top swap
+//
+#define GEN_STATUS 0xD4
+#define TOP_SWAP_BIT (1 << 13)
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+ReadPciRegister (
+ IN UINT32 Offset
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Read PCI register value.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ Offset - Offset of the register
+
+Returns:
+
+ The value.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINT32 Value;
+ EFI_PCI_ROOT_BRIDGE_IO_PROTOCOL *PciRootBridgeIo;
+
+ Value = 0;
+ Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &PciRootBridgeIo);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Locate PCI root bridge io protocol - %r", Status));
+ return 0;
+ }
+
+ Status = PciRootBridgeIo->Pci.Read (
+ PciRootBridgeIo,
+ EfiPciWidthUint32,
+ EFI_PCI_ADDRESS (
+ LPC_BUS_NUMBER,
+ LPC_DEVICE_NUMBER,
+ LPC_IF,
+ Offset
+ ),
+ 1,
+ &Value
+ );
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ return Value;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+GetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *SwapState
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Get swap state
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ SwapState - Swap state
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS - State successfully got
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // Top swap status is 13 bit
+ //
+ *SwapState = (BOOLEAN) ((ReadPciRegister (GEN_STATUS) & TOP_SWAP_BIT) != 0);
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+SetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN BOOLEAN TopSwap
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Set swap state.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Indicates a pointer to the calling context.
+ TopSwap - New swap state
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+
+Note:
+ the Top-Swap bit (bit 13, D31: F0, Offset D4h). Note that
+ software will not be able to clear the Top-Swap bit until the system is
+ rebooted without GNT[A]# being pulled down.
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINT32 GenStatus;
+ EFI_PCI_ROOT_BRIDGE_IO_PROTOCOL *PciRootBridgeIo;
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // Top-Swap bit (bit 13, D31: F0, Offset D4h)
+ //
+ GenStatus = ReadPciRegister (GEN_STATUS);
+
+ //
+ // Set 13 bit, according to input NewSwapState
+ //
+ if (TopSwap) {
+ GenStatus |= TOP_SWAP_BIT;
+ } else {
+ GenStatus &= ~TOP_SWAP_BIT;
+ }
+
+ Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiPciRootBridgeIoProtocolGuid, NULL, (VOID **) &PciRootBridgeIo);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Locate PCI root bridge io protocol - %r", Status));
+ return Status;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write back the GenStatus register
+ //
+ Status = PciRootBridgeIo->Pci.Write (
+ PciRootBridgeIo,
+ EfiPciWidthUint32,
+ EFI_PCI_ADDRESS (
+ LPC_BUS_NUMBER,
+ LPC_DEVICE_NUMBER,
+ LPC_IF,
+ GEN_STATUS
+ ),
+ 1,
+ &GenStatus
+ );
+
+ DEBUG_CODE_BEGIN ();
+ if (TopSwap) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SAR: Set top swap\n"));
+ } else {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "SAR: Clear top swap\n"));
+ }
+ DEBUG_CODE_END ();
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether the block is a boot block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - Lba value
+
+Returns:
+
+ Is a boot block or not
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *BootFvb;
+
+ Status = GetFvbByAddress (BOOT_BLOCK_BASE, &BootFvb);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ return FALSE;
+ }
+ //
+ // Compare the Fvb
+ //
+ return (BOOLEAN) (FvBlock == BootFvb);
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a boot block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Boot block is accessed by BootFvb protocol interface. LBA is 0.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to boot block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+ FTW will do extra work on boot block update.
+ FTW should depend on a protocol of EFI_ADDRESS_RANGE_SWAP_PROTOCOL,
+ which is produced by a chipset driver.
+
+ FTW updating boot block steps:
+ 1. Erase top swap block (0xFFFE-0xFFFEFFFF) and write data to it ready
+ 2. Read data from top swap block to memory buffer
+ 3. SetSwapState(EFI_SWAPPED)
+ 4. Erasing boot block (0xFFFF-0xFFFFFFFF)
+ 5. Programming boot block until the boot block is ok.
+ 6. SetSwapState(UNSWAPPED)
+
+ Notes:
+ 1. Since the SwapState bit is saved in CMOS, FTW can restore and continue
+ even in the scenario of power failure.
+ 2. FTW shall not allow to update boot block when battery state is error.
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ UINTN Length;
+ UINT8 *Buffer;
+ UINTN Count;
+ UINT8 *Ptr;
+ UINTN Index;
+ BOOLEAN TopSwap;
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *BootFvb;
+ EFI_LBA BootLba;
+
+ //
+ // Allocate a memory buffer
+ //
+ Length = FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaLength;
+ Buffer = AllocatePool (Length);
+ if (Buffer == NULL) {
+ }
+ //
+ // Get TopSwap bit state
+ //
+ Status = GetSwapState (FtwLiteDevice, &TopSwap);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Get Top Swapped status - %r\n", Status));
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+
+ if (TopSwap) {
+ //
+ // Get FVB of current boot block
+ //
+ Status = GetFvbByAddress (FtwLiteDevice->SpareAreaAddress + FTW_BLOCK_SIZE, &BootFvb);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+ //
+ // Read data from current boot block
+ //
+ BootLba = 0;
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = BootFvb->Read (
+ BootFvb,
+ BootLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Read data from spare block
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Read (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+ //
+ // Set TopSwap bit
+ //
+ Status = SetSwapState (FtwLiteDevice, TRUE);
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Set Swap State - %r\n", Status));
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+ }
+ //
+ // Erase boot block. After setting TopSwap bit, it's spare block now!
+ //
+ Status = FtwEraseSpareBlock (FtwLiteDevice);
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return EFI_ABORTED;
+ }
+ //
+ // Write memory buffer to currenet spare block
+ //
+ Ptr = Buffer;
+ for (Index = 0; Index < FtwLiteDevice->NumberOfSpareBlock; Index += 1) {
+ Count = FtwLiteDevice->SizeOfSpareBlock;
+ Status = FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb->Write (
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwBackupFvb,
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba + Index,
+ 0,
+ &Count,
+ Ptr
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_FTW_LITE, "FtwLite: FVB Write boot block - %r\n", Status));
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+ return Status;
+ }
+
+ Ptr += Count;
+ }
+
+ FreePool (Buffer);
+
+ //
+ // Clear TopSwap bit
+ //
+ Status = SetSwapState (FtwLiteDevice, FALSE);
+ DEBUG ((EFI_D_ERROR, "FtwLite: Clear Swap State - %r\n", Status));
+ ASSERT_EFI_ERROR (Status);
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ipf/IpfFtwMisc.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ipf/IpfFtwMisc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d31883b --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/Ipf/IpfFtwMisc.c @@ -0,0 +1,143 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ IpfFtwMisc.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Ipf platform related code to support FtwLite..
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+//
+// MACROs for boot block update
+//
+#define BOOT_BLOCK_BASE
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+GetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *SwapState
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Get swap state
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ SwapState - Swap state
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS - State successfully got
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+SetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN BOOLEAN TopSwap
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Set swap state.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Indicates a pointer to the calling context.
+ TopSwap - New swap state
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+
+Note:
+ the Top-Swap bit (bit 13, D31: F0, Offset D4h). Note that
+ software will not be able to clear the Top-Swap bit until the system is
+ rebooted without GNT[A]# being pulled down.
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether the block is a boot block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - Lba value
+
+Returns:
+
+ Is a boot block or not
+
+--*/
+{
+ //
+ // IPF doesn't support safe bootblock update
+ // so treat bootblock as normal block
+ //
+ return FALSE;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a boot block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Boot block is accessed by BootFvb protocol interface. LBA is 0.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to boot block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/x64/x64FtwMisc.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/x64/x64FtwMisc.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d8e3a03 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/FaultTolerantWriteLite/Dxe/x64/x64FtwMisc.c @@ -0,0 +1,140 @@ +
+/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ x64FtwMisc.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ X64 platform related code to support FtwLite..
+
+Revision History
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include <FtwLite.h>
+
+//
+// MACROs for boot block update
+//
+#define BOOT_BLOCK_BASE
+
+// STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+GetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *SwapState
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Get swap state
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ SwapState - Swap state
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS - State successfully got
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+// STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+SetSwapState (
+ IN EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ IN BOOLEAN TopSwap
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Set swap state.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - Indicates a pointer to the calling context.
+ TopSwap - New swap state
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - The function completed successfully
+
+Note:
+ the Top-Swap bit (bit 13, D31: F0, Offset D4h). Note that
+ software will not be able to clear the Top-Swap bit until the system is
+ rebooted without GNT[A]# being pulled down.
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+BOOLEAN
+IsBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice,
+ EFI_FIRMWARE_VOLUME_BLOCK_PROTOCOL *FvBlock,
+ EFI_LBA Lba
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Check whether the block is a boot block.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ FtwLiteDevice - Calling context
+ FvBlock - Fvb protocol instance
+ Lba - Lba value
+
+Returns:
+
+ Is a boot block or not
+
+--*/
+{
+ return FALSE;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+FlushSpareBlockToBootBlock (
+ EFI_FTW_LITE_DEVICE *FtwLiteDevice
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+ Copy the content of spare block to a boot block. Size is FTW_BLOCK_SIZE.
+ Spare block is accessed by FTW backup FVB protocol interface. LBA is
+ FtwLiteDevice->FtwSpareLba.
+ Boot block is accessed by BootFvb protocol interface. LBA is 0.
+
+Arguments:
+ FtwLiteDevice - The private data of FTW_LITE driver
+
+Returns:
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Spare block content is copied to boot block
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - Input parameter error
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Allocate memory error
+ EFI_ABORTED - The function could not complete successfully
+
+Notes:
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..de9ba83 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.c @@ -0,0 +1,230 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ Crc32SectionExtract.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Implements GUIDed section extraction protocol interface with
+ a specific GUID: CRC32.
+
+ Please refer to the Framewokr Firmware Volume Specification 0.9.
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include <GuidedSection.h>
+#include <Crc32SectionExtract.h>
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocol (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Entry point of the CRC32 GUIDed section extraction protocol.
+ Creates and initializes an instance of the GUIDed section
+ extraction protocol with CRC32 GUID.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle EFI_HANDLE: A handle for the image that is initializing
+ this driver
+ SystemTable EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE: A pointer to the EFI system table
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS: Driver initialized successfully
+ EFI_LOAD_ERROR: Failed to Initialize or has been loaded
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES: Could not allocate needed resources
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL *Crc32GuidedSep;
+ EFI_HANDLE Handle;
+
+ //
+ // Call all constructors per produced protocols
+ //
+ Status = GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolConstructor (
+ &Crc32GuidedSep,
+ (EFI_EXTRACT_GUIDED_SECTION) Crc32ExtractSection
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ if (Crc32GuidedSep != NULL) {
+ FreePool (Crc32GuidedSep);
+ }
+
+ return Status;
+ }
+ //
+ // Pass in a NULL to install to a new handle
+ //
+ Handle = NULL;
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (
+ &Handle,
+ &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolGuid,
+ EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
+ Crc32GuidedSep
+ );
+ if (EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ FreePool (Crc32GuidedSep);
+ return EFI_LOAD_ERROR;
+ }
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+STATIC
+UINT32
+EFIAPI
+GetSectionLength (
+ IN EFI_COMMON_SECTION_HEADER *CommonHeader
+ )
+/*++
+
+ Routine Description:
+ Get a length of section.
+
+ Parameters:
+ CommonHeader - Pointer to the common section header.
+
+ Return Value:
+ The length of the section, including the section header.
+
+--*/
+// TODO: function comment is missing 'Arguments:'
+// TODO: function comment is missing 'Returns:'
+// TODO: CommonHeader - add argument and description to function comment
+{
+ UINT32 Size;
+
+ Size = *(UINT32 *) CommonHeader->Size & 0x00FFFFFF;
+
+ return Size;
+}
+
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+Crc32ExtractSection (
+ IN EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN VOID *InputSection,
+ OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
+ OUT UINTN *OutputSize,
+ OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
+ )
+/*++
+
+ Routine Description:
+ This function reads and extracts contents of a section from an
+ encapsulating section.
+
+ Parameters:
+ This - Indicates the calling context.
+ InputSection - Buffer containing the input GUIDed section
+ to be processed.
+ OutputBuffer - *OutputBuffer is allocated from boot services
+ pool memory and containing the new section
+ stream. The caller is responsible for freeing
+ this buffer.
+ AuthenticationStatus - Pointer to a caller allocated UINT32 that
+ indicates the authentication status of the
+ output buffer
+
+ Return Value:
+ EFI_SUCCESS
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES
+ EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER
+ EFI_NOT_AVAILABLE_YET
+
+--*/
+// TODO: function comment is missing 'Arguments:'
+// TODO: function comment is missing 'Returns:'
+// TODO: This - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: InputSection - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: OutputBuffer - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: OutputSize - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: AuthenticationStatus - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - add return value to function comment
+// TODO: EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER - add return value to function comment
+// TODO: EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - add return value to function comment
+// TODO: EFI_SUCCESS - add return value to function comment
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+ CRC32_SECTION_HEADER *Crc32SectionHeader;
+ EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *GuidedSectionHeader;
+ UINT8 *Image;
+ UINT32 Crc32Checksum;
+ VOID *DummyInterface;
+
+ if (OutputBuffer == NULL) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ *OutputBuffer = NULL;
+
+ //
+ // Points to the section header
+ //
+ Crc32SectionHeader = (CRC32_SECTION_HEADER *) InputSection;
+ GuidedSectionHeader = (EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION *) InputSection;
+
+ //
+ // Check if the GUID is a CRC32 section GUID
+ //
+ if (!CompareGuid (
+ &(GuidedSectionHeader->SectionDefinitionGuid),
+ &gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolGuid
+ )) {
+ return EFI_INVALID_PARAMETER;
+ }
+
+ Image = (UINT8 *) InputSection + (UINT32) (GuidedSectionHeader->DataOffset);
+ *OutputSize = GetSectionLength ((EFI_COMMON_SECTION_HEADER *) InputSection) - (UINT32) GuidedSectionHeader->DataOffset;
+
+ *OutputBuffer = AllocatePool (*OutputSize);
+ if (*OutputBuffer == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+ //
+ // Implictly CRC32 GUIDed section should have STATUS_VALID bit set
+ //
+ ASSERT (GuidedSectionHeader->Attributes & EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_AUTH_STATUS_VALID);
+ *AuthenticationStatus = EFI_LOCAL_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED | EFI_AGGREGATE_AUTH_STATUS_IMAGE_SIGNED;
+
+ //
+ // Check whether there exists EFI_SECURITY_POLICY_PROTOCOL_GUID.
+ //
+ Status = gBS->LocateProtocol (&gEfiSecurityPolicyProtocolGuid, NULL, &DummyInterface);
+ if (!EFI_ERROR (Status)) {
+ *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_LOCAL_AUTH_STATUS_PLATFORM_OVERRIDE | EFI_AGGREGATE_AUTH_STATUS_PLATFORM_OVERRIDE;
+ } else {
+ //
+ // Calculate CRC32 Checksum of Image
+ //
+ gBS->CalculateCrc32 (Image, *OutputSize, &Crc32Checksum);
+ if (Crc32Checksum != Crc32SectionHeader->CRC32Checksum) {
+ *AuthenticationStatus |= EFI_LOCAL_AUTH_STATUS_TEST_FAILED | EFI_AGGREGATE_AUTH_STATUS_TEST_FAILED;
+ }
+ }
+
+ CopyMem (*OutputBuffer, Image, *OutputSize);
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.dxs b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.dxs new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d42975a --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.dxs @@ -0,0 +1,26 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ Crc32SectionExtraction.dxs
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Dependency expression file.
+
+--*/
+#include "DxeDepex.h"
+
+DEPENDENCY_START
+ EFI_RUNTIME_ARCH_PROTOCOL_GUID
+DEPENDENCY_END
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..37af840 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.h @@ -0,0 +1,112 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ Crc32SectionExtract.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Header file for Crc32SectionExtract.c
+ Please refer to the Framewokr Firmware Volume Specification 0.9.
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _CRC32_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_H
+#define _CRC32_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_H
+
+//
+// The package level header files this module uses
+//
+#include <PiDxe.h>
+//
+// The protocols, PPI and GUID defintions for this module
+//
+#include <Protocol/SecurityPolicy.h>
+#include <Protocol/GuidedSectionExtaction.h>
+//
+// The Library classes this module consumes
+//
+#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
+#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiDriverEntryPoint.h>
+#include <Library/BaseMemoryLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
+
+typedef struct {
+ EFI_GUID_DEFINED_SECTION GuidedSectionHeader;
+ UINT32 CRC32Checksum;
+} CRC32_SECTION_HEADER;
+
+//
+// Function prototype declarations
+//
+STATIC
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+Crc32ExtractSection (
+ IN EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN VOID *InputSection,
+ OUT VOID **OutputBuffer,
+ OUT UINTN *OutputSize,
+ OUT UINT32 *AuthenticationStatus
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ TODO: Add function description
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This - TODO: add argument description
+ InputSection - TODO: add argument description
+ OutputBuffer - TODO: add argument description
+ OutputSize - TODO: add argument description
+ AuthenticationStatus - TODO: add argument description
+
+Returns:
+
+ TODO: add return values
+
+--*/
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocol (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Entry point of the CRC32 GUIDed section extraction protocol.
+ Creates and initializes an instance of the GUIDed section
+ extraction protocol with CRC32 GUID.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle EFI_HANDLE: A handle for the image that is initializing
+ this driver
+ SystemTable EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE: A pointer to the EFI system table
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS: Driver initialized successfully
+ EFI_LOAD_ERROR: Failed to Initialize or has been loaded
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES: Could not allocate needed resources
+
+--*/
+;
+
+#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000..69becb8 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.inf @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +#/** @file
+# Component description file for Crc32SectionExtract module.
+#
+# This driver implements CRC32 GUIDed section extraction protocol interface.
+# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+#
+# All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#
+#
+#**/
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Defines Section - statements that will be processed to create a Makefile.
+#
+################################################################################
+[Defines]
+ INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
+ BASE_NAME = Crc32SectionExtract
+ FILE_GUID = 51C9F40C-5243-4473-B265-B3C8FFAFF9FA
+ MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
+ VERSION_STRING = 1.0
+ EDK_RELEASE_VERSION = 0x00020000
+ EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x00020000
+
+ ENTRY_POINT = InitializeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocol
+
+#
+# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
+#
+# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
+#
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Sources Section - list of files that are required for the build to succeed.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Sources.common]
+ Crc32SectionExtract.dxs
+ GuidedSection.h
+ GuidedSection.c
+ Crc32SectionExtract.h
+ Crc32SectionExtract.c
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Package Dependency Section - list of Package files that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Packages]
+ MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
+ IntelFrameworkPkg/IntelFrameworkPkg.dec
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Library Class Section - list of Library Classes that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[LibraryClasses]
+ MemoryAllocationLib
+ UefiBootServicesTableLib
+ BaseMemoryLib
+ UefiDriverEntryPoint
+ DebugLib
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Protocol C Name Section - list of Protocol and Protocol Notify C Names
+# that this module uses or produces.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Protocols]
+ gEfiSecurityPolicyProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL SOMETIMES_CONSUMED
+ gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_PRODUCED
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.msa b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.msa new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a4ab182 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/Crc32SectionExtract.msa @@ -0,0 +1,66 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
+<ModuleSurfaceArea xmlns="http://www.TianoCore.org/2006/Edk2.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance">
+ <MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleName>Crc32SectionExtract</ModuleName>
+ <ModuleType>DXE_DRIVER</ModuleType>
+ <GuidValue>51C9F40C-5243-4473-B265-B3C8FFAFF9FA</GuidValue>
+ <Version>1.0</Version>
+ <Abstract>Component description file for Crc32SectionExtract module.</Abstract>
+ <Description>This driver implements CRC32 GUIDed section extraction protocol interface.</Description>
+ <Copyright>Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation</Copyright>
+ <License>All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+ are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+ which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+ http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+ THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+ WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.</License>
+ <Specification>FRAMEWORK_BUILD_PACKAGING_SPECIFICATION 0x00000052</Specification>
+ </MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleDefinitions>
+ <SupportedArchitectures>IA32 X64 IPF EBC</SupportedArchitectures>
+ <BinaryModule>false</BinaryModule>
+ <OutputFileBasename>Crc32SectionExtract</OutputFileBasename>
+ </ModuleDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>DebugLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiDriverEntryPoint</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>BaseMemoryLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiBootServicesTableLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>MemoryAllocationLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ </LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <SourceFiles>
+ <Filename>Crc32SectionExtract.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>Crc32SectionExtract.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>GuidedSection.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>GuidedSection.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>Crc32SectionExtract.dxs</Filename>
+ </SourceFiles>
+ <PackageDependencies>
+ <Package PackageGuid="1E73767F-8F52-4603-AEB4-F29B510B6766"/>
+ </PackageDependencies>
+ <Protocols>
+ <Protocol Usage="SOMETIMES_CONSUMED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiSecurityPolicyProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_PRODUCED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ </Protocols>
+ <Externs>
+ <Specification>EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Specification>EDK_RELEASE_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Extern>
+ <ModuleEntryPoint>InitializeCrc32GuidedSectionExtractionProtocol</ModuleEntryPoint>
+ </Extern>
+ </Externs>
+</ModuleSurfaceArea>
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..87605cc --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.c @@ -0,0 +1,61 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ GuidedSection.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+ GUIDed section extraction protocol implementation.
+ This contains the common constructor of GUIDed section
+ extraction protocol. GUID specific implementation of each
+ GUIDed section extraction protocol can be found in other
+ files under the same directory.
+
+--*/
+
+#include "GuidedSection.h"
+
+EFI_STATUS
+GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolConstructor (
+ OUT EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL **GuidedSep,
+ IN EFI_EXTRACT_GUIDED_SECTION ExtractSection
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ Constructor for the GUIDed section extraction protocol. Initializes
+ instance data.
+
+Arguments:
+
+ This Instance to construct
+
+Returns:
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS: Instance initialized.
+
+--*/
+// TODO: GuidedSep - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: ExtractSection - add argument and description to function comment
+// TODO: EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - add return value to function comment
+{
+ *GuidedSep = AllocatePool (sizeof (EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL));
+ if (*GuidedSep == NULL) {
+ return EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES;
+ }
+
+ (*GuidedSep)->ExtractSection = ExtractSection;
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..d6613b0 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/FirmwareVolume/GuidedSectionExtraction/Crc32SectionExtract/Dxe/GuidedSection.h @@ -0,0 +1,54 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ GuidedSection.h
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Header file for GuidedSection.c
+ Please refer to the Framewokr Firmware Volume Specification 0.9.
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_H
+#define _GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_H
+
+#include "Crc32SectionExtract.h"
+
+//
+// Function prototype declarations
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+GuidedSectionExtractionProtocolConstructor (
+ OUT EFI_GUIDED_SECTION_EXTRACTION_PROTOCOL **GuidedSep,
+ IN EFI_EXTRACT_GUIDED_SECTION ExtractSection
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ TODO: Add function description
+
+Arguments:
+
+ GuidedSep - TODO: add argument description
+ ExtractSection - TODO: add argument description
+
+Returns:
+
+ TODO: add return values
+
+--*/
+;
+
+#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.c b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000..7a20a41 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.c @@ -0,0 +1,214 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ NullMemoryTest.c
+
+Abstract:
+
+--*/
+
+
+#include "NullMemoryTest.h"
+
+//
+// Module global members
+//
+UINT64 mTestedSystemMemory = 0;
+UINT64 mTotalSystemMemory = 0;
+EFI_HANDLE mGenericMemoryTestHandle;
+
+//
+// Driver entry here
+//
+EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL mGenericMemoryTest = {
+ InitializeMemoryTest,
+ GenPerformMemoryTest,
+ GenMemoryTestFinished,
+ GenCompatibleRangeTest
+};
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenericMemoryTestEntryPoint (
+ IN EFI_HANDLE ImageHandle,
+ IN EFI_SYSTEM_TABLE *SystemTable
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+ The generic memory test driver's entry point, it can initialize private data
+ to default value
+
+Arguments:
+
+ ImageHandle of the loaded driver
+ Pointer to the System Table
+
+Returns:
+
+ Status
+
+ EFI_SUCCESS - Protocol successfully installed
+ EFI_OUT_OF_RESOURCES - Can not allocate protocol data structure in base
+ memory
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_STATUS Status;
+
+ //
+ // Install the protocol
+ //
+ Status = gBS->InstallProtocolInterface (
+ &mGenericMemoryTestHandle,
+ &gEfiGenericMemTestProtocolGuid,
+ EFI_NATIVE_INTERFACE,
+ &mGenericMemoryTest
+ );
+
+ return Status;
+}
+//
+// EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL implementation
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeMemoryTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EXTENDMEM_COVERAGE_LEVEL Level,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *RequireSoftECCInit
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+Arguments:
+
+Returns:
+
+--*/
+{
+ UINTN NumberOfDescriptors;
+ EFI_GCD_MEMORY_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR *MemorySpaceMap;
+ UINTN Index;
+
+ gDS->GetMemorySpaceMap (&NumberOfDescriptors, &MemorySpaceMap);
+ for (Index = 0; Index < NumberOfDescriptors; Index++) {
+ if (MemorySpaceMap[Index].GcdMemoryType == EfiGcdMemoryTypeReserved &&
+ (MemorySpaceMap[Index].Capabilities & (EFI_MEMORY_PRESENT | EFI_MEMORY_INITIALIZED | EFI_MEMORY_TESTED)) ==
+ (EFI_MEMORY_PRESENT | EFI_MEMORY_INITIALIZED)
+ ) {
+ gDS->RemoveMemorySpace (
+ MemorySpaceMap[Index].BaseAddress,
+ MemorySpaceMap[Index].Length
+ );
+
+ gDS->AddMemorySpace (
+ EfiGcdMemoryTypeSystemMemory,
+ MemorySpaceMap[Index].BaseAddress,
+ MemorySpaceMap[Index].Length,
+ MemorySpaceMap[Index].Capabilities &~
+ (EFI_MEMORY_PRESENT | EFI_MEMORY_INITIALIZED | EFI_MEMORY_TESTED | EFI_MEMORY_RUNTIME)
+ );
+
+ mTestedSystemMemory += MemorySpaceMap[Index].Length;
+ mTotalSystemMemory += MemorySpaceMap[Index].Length;
+ } else if (MemorySpaceMap[Index].GcdMemoryType == EfiGcdMemoryTypeSystemMemory) {
+ mTotalSystemMemory += MemorySpaceMap[Index].Length;
+ }
+ }
+
+ FreePool (MemorySpaceMap);
+
+ *RequireSoftECCInit = FALSE;
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenPerformMemoryTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN OUT UINT64 *TestedMemorySize,
+ OUT UINT64 *TotalMemorySize,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *ErrorOut,
+ IN BOOLEAN TestAbort
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+Arguments:
+
+Returns:
+
+--*/
+{
+ *ErrorOut = FALSE;
+ *TestedMemorySize = mTestedSystemMemory;
+ *TotalMemorySize = mTotalSystemMemory;
+
+ return EFI_NOT_FOUND;
+
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenMemoryTestFinished (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+Arguments:
+
+Returns:
+
+--*/
+{
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenCompatibleRangeTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS StartAddress,
+ IN UINT64 Length
+ )
+/*++
+
+Routine Description:
+
+Arguments:
+
+Returns:
+
+--*/
+{
+ EFI_GCD_MEMORY_SPACE_DESCRIPTOR descriptor;
+
+ gDS->GetMemorySpaceDescriptor (StartAddress, &descriptor);
+
+ gDS->RemoveMemorySpace (StartAddress, Length);
+
+ gDS->AddMemorySpace (
+ EfiGcdMemoryTypeSystemMemory,
+ StartAddress,
+ Length,
+ descriptor.Capabilities &~(EFI_MEMORY_PRESENT | EFI_MEMORY_INITIALIZED | EFI_MEMORY_TESTED | EFI_MEMORY_RUNTIME)
+ );
+
+ return EFI_SUCCESS;
+}
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.dxs b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.dxs new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a1ac031 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.dxs @@ -0,0 +1,25 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ NullMemoryTest.dxs
+
+Abstract:
+
+ Dependency expression source file.
+
+--*/
+#include <DxeDepex.h>
+
+DEPENDENCY_START
+ TRUE
+DEPENDENCY_END
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.h b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000..4b04381 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.h @@ -0,0 +1,124 @@ +/*++
+
+Copyright (c) 2006, Intel Corporation
+All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+
+THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+
+Module Name:
+
+ NullMemoryTest.h
+
+Abstract:
+ The generic memory test driver definition
+
+--*/
+
+#ifndef _NULL_MEMORY_TEST_H
+#define _NULL_MEMORY_TEST_H
+
+//
+// The package level header files this module uses
+//
+#include <PiDxe.h>
+
+//
+// The protocols, PPI and GUID defintions for this module
+//
+#include <Protocol/GenericMemoryTest.h>
+//
+// The Library classes this module consumes
+//
+#include <Library/DebugLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiDriverEntryPoint.h>
+#include <Library/DxeServicesTableLib.h>
+#include <Library/UefiBootServicesTableLib.h>
+#include <Library/MemoryAllocationLib.h>
+
+//
+// attributes for reserved memory before it is promoted to system memory
+//
+#define EFI_MEMORY_PRESENT 0x0100000000000000ULL
+#define EFI_MEMORY_INITIALIZED 0x0200000000000000ULL
+#define EFI_MEMORY_TESTED 0x0400000000000000ULL
+
+
+//
+// Some global define
+//
+#define GENERIC_CACHELINE_SIZE 0x40
+
+//
+// The SPARSE_SPAN_SIZE size can not small then the MonoTestSize
+//
+#define TEST_BLOCK_SIZE 0x2000000
+#define QUICK_SPAN_SIZE (TEST_BLOCK_SIZE >> 2)
+#define SPARSE_SPAN_SIZE (TEST_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)
+
+//
+// This structure records every nontested memory range parsed through GCD
+// service.
+//
+#define EFI_NONTESTED_MEMORY_RANGE_SIGNATURE EFI_SIGNATURE_32 ('N', 'T', 'M', 'E')
+typedef struct {
+ UINTN Signature;
+ LIST_ENTRY Link;
+ EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS StartAddress;
+ UINT64 Length;
+ UINT64 Capabilities;
+ BOOLEAN Above4G;
+ BOOLEAN AlreadyMapped;
+} NONTESTED_MEMORY_RANGE;
+
+#define NONTESTED_MEMORY_RANGE_FROM_LINK(link) \
+ CR(link, NONTESTED_MEMORY_RANGE, Link, EFI_NONTESTED_MEMORY_RANGE_SIGNATURE)
+
+//
+// This is the memory test driver's structure definition
+//
+#define EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PRIVATE_SIGNATURE EFI_SIGNATURE_32 ('G', 'E', 'M', 'T')
+
+//
+// Function Prototypes
+//
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+InitializeMemoryTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EXTENDMEM_COVERAGE_LEVEL Level,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *RequireSoftECCInit
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenPerformMemoryTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN OUT UINT64 *TestedMemorySize,
+ OUT UINT64 *TotalMemorySize,
+ OUT BOOLEAN *ErrorOut,
+ IN BOOLEAN TestAbort
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenMemoryTestFinished (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This
+ )
+;
+
+EFI_STATUS
+EFIAPI
+GenCompatibleRangeTest (
+ IN EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL *This,
+ IN EFI_PHYSICAL_ADDRESS StartAddress,
+ IN UINT64 Length
+ )
+;
+
+#endif
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.inf b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.inf new file mode 100644 index 0000000..f10ed27 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.inf @@ -0,0 +1,88 @@ +#/** @file
+# Component description file for NullMemoryTest module.
+#
+# This driver installs EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL to
+# provide simple generic memory test functions.
+# Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation
+#
+# All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+# are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+# which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+# http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+# THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.
+#
+#
+#**/
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Defines Section - statements that will be processed to create a Makefile.
+#
+################################################################################
+[Defines]
+ INF_VERSION = 0x00010005
+ BASE_NAME = NullMemoryTest
+ FILE_GUID = 96B5C032-DF4C-4b6e-8232-438DCF448D0E
+ MODULE_TYPE = DXE_DRIVER
+ VERSION_STRING = 1.0
+ EDK_RELEASE_VERSION = 0x00020000
+ EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION = 0x00020000
+
+ ENTRY_POINT = GenericMemoryTestEntryPoint
+
+#
+# The following information is for reference only and not required by the build tools.
+#
+# VALID_ARCHITECTURES = IA32 X64 IPF EBC
+#
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Sources Section - list of files that are required for the build to succeed.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Sources.common]
+ NullMemoryTest.dxs
+ NullMemoryTest.h
+ NullMemoryTest.c
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Package Dependency Section - list of Package files that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Packages]
+ MdeModulePkg/MdeModulePkg.dec
+ MdePkg/MdePkg.dec
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Library Class Section - list of Library Classes that are required for
+# this module.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[LibraryClasses]
+ MemoryAllocationLib
+ UefiBootServicesTableLib
+ DxeServicesTableLib
+ UefiDriverEntryPoint
+ DebugLib
+
+
+################################################################################
+#
+# Protocol C Name Section - list of Protocol and Protocol Notify C Names
+# that this module uses or produces.
+#
+################################################################################
+
+[Protocols]
+ gEfiGenericMemTestProtocolGuid # PROTOCOL ALWAYS_PRODUCED
+
diff --git a/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.msa b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.msa new file mode 100644 index 0000000..ade8ce1 --- /dev/null +++ b/MdeModulePkg/Universal/GenericMemoryTest/Dxe/NullMemoryTest.msa @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
+<ModuleSurfaceArea xmlns="http://www.TianoCore.org/2006/Edk2.0" xmlns:xsi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema-instance">
+ <MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleName>NullMemoryTest</ModuleName>
+ <ModuleType>DXE_DRIVER</ModuleType>
+ <GuidValue>96B5C032-DF4C-4b6e-8232-438DCF448D0E</GuidValue>
+ <Version>1.0</Version>
+ <Abstract>Component description file for NullMemoryTest module.</Abstract>
+ <Description>This driver installs EFI_GENERIC_MEMORY_TEST_PROTOCOL to
+ provide simple generic memory test functions.</Description>
+ <Copyright>Copyright (c) 2006 - 2007, Intel Corporation</Copyright>
+ <License>All rights reserved. This program and the accompanying materials
+ are licensed and made available under the terms and conditions of the BSD License
+ which accompanies this distribution. The full text of the license may be found at
+ http://opensource.org/licenses/bsd-license.php
+ THE PROGRAM IS DISTRIBUTED UNDER THE BSD LICENSE ON AN "AS IS" BASIS,
+ WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR REPRESENTATIONS OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED.</License>
+ <Specification>FRAMEWORK_BUILD_PACKAGING_SPECIFICATION 0x00000052</Specification>
+ </MsaHeader>
+ <ModuleDefinitions>
+ <SupportedArchitectures>IA32 X64 IPF EBC</SupportedArchitectures>
+ <BinaryModule>false</BinaryModule>
+ <OutputFileBasename>NullMemoryTest</OutputFileBasename>
+ </ModuleDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>DebugLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiDriverEntryPoint</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>DxeServicesTableLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>UefiBootServicesTableLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ <LibraryClass Usage="ALWAYS_CONSUMED">
+ <Keyword>MemoryAllocationLib</Keyword>
+ </LibraryClass>
+ </LibraryClassDefinitions>
+ <SourceFiles>
+ <Filename>Common.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>NullMemoryTest.c</Filename>
+ <Filename>NullMemoryTest.h</Filename>
+ <Filename>NullMemoryTest.dxs</Filename>
+ </SourceFiles>
+ <PackageDependencies>
+ <Package PackageGuid="1E73767F-8F52-4603-AEB4-F29B510B6766"/>
+ <Package PackageGuid="BA0D78D6-2CAF-414b-BD4D-B6762A894288"/>
+ </PackageDependencies>
+ <Protocols>
+ <Protocol Usage="ALWAYS_PRODUCED">
+ <ProtocolCName>gEfiGenericMemTestProtocolGuid</ProtocolCName>
+ </Protocol>
+ </Protocols>
+ <Externs>
+ <Specification>EFI_SPECIFICATION_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Specification>EDK_RELEASE_VERSION 0x00020000</Specification>
+ <Extern>
+ <ModuleEntryPoint>GenericMemoryTestEntryPoint</ModuleEntryPoint>
+ </Extern>
+ </Externs>
+</ModuleSurfaceArea>
|